]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
Fix last change.
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
959acfd1 34@set DATE December 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
59Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
60Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
61and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
96Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
97Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
98and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65
EZ
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 129* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 130* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
131
132* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
133
134* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
135* Altering:: Altering execution
136* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
137* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
138* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
139* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
140* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 141* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
142* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
143* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 144* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
145
146* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
147* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
148
149* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
150* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
151* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
152* Index:: Index
153@end menu
154
b9deaee7 155@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
156
157@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
158
159@ifhtml
160@node Top
161
162@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
163
164This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
165
b37052ae 166This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
6d2ebf8b
SS
167@value{GDBVN}.
168
169Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
170
c906108c
SS
171@menu
172* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 173* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
174
175* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
176* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
177* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
178* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
179* Stack:: Examining the stack
180* Source:: Examining source files
181* Data:: Examining data
496e6bc3 182* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 183* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
c906108c 184
7a292a7a 185* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
186
187* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
188* Altering:: Altering execution
189* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
190* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 191* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
192* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
193* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
496e6bc3 194* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
c906108c 195* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 196* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
496e6bc3 197* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
c906108c
SS
198
199* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 200* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
201
202* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
203* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
204* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
205* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
206@end menu
207
6d2ebf8b
SS
208@end ifhtml
209
449f3b6c
AC
210@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
211@iftex
212@contents
213@end iftex
214
6d2ebf8b 215@node Summary
c906108c
SS
216@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
217
218The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
219going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
220program was doing at the moment it crashed.
221
222@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
223these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
224
225@itemize @bullet
226@item
227Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
228
229@item
230Make your program stop on specified conditions.
231
232@item
233Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
234
235@item
236Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
237effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
238@end itemize
239
cce74817 240You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 241For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
242For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
243
cce74817
JM
244@cindex Chill
245@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 246Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 247see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 248
cce74817
JM
249@cindex Pascal
250Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
251nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
252entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
253syntax.
c906108c 254
c906108c
SS
255@cindex Fortran
256@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 257it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 258underscore.
c906108c 259
c906108c
SS
260@menu
261* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
262* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
263@end menu
264
6d2ebf8b 265@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
266@unnumberedsec Free software
267
5d161b24 268@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
269General Public License
270(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
271program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
272freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
273the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
274Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
275Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
276
277Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
278you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
279from anyone else.
280
2666264b 281@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
282
283The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
284the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
285include with the free software. Many of our most important
286programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
287texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
288when an important free software package does not come with a free
289manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
290gaps today.
291
292Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
293normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
294authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
295copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
296them from the free software world.
297
298That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
299from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
300manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
301only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
302contract to make it non-free.
303
304Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
305price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
306charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
307Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
308problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
309are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
310modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
311
312The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
313free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
314commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
315accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
316
317Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
318When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
319are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
320provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
321manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
322a changed version of the program is not really available to our
323community.
324
325Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
326acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
327author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
328authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
329to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
330may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
331with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
332are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
333of the manual.
334
335However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
336content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
337media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
338obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
339manual to replace it.
340
341Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
342lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
343free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
344the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
345realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
346the free software community.
347
348If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
349the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
350license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
351don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
352will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
353option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
354what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
355try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
356is free, write to @email{icensing@@gnu.org}.
357
358You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
359manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
360copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
361improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
362at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
363and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
364Check the history of the book, and try reward the publishers that have
365paid or pay the authors to work on it.
366
367The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
368published by other publishers, at
369@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
370
6d2ebf8b 371@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
372@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
373
374Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
375other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
376development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
377of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
378to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
379file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
380blow-by-blow account.
381
382Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
383
384@quotation
385@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
386or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
387omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
388@end quotation
389
390So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
391particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
392releases:
b37052ae 393Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
394Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
395Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
396Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
397Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
398Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
399John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
400Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
401and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
402
403Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
404Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
405
b37052ae
EZ
406Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
407in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
408Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
409demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
410much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 411
b37052ae 412@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
413object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
414Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
415
416David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
417the original support for encapsulated COFF.
418
96c405b3 419Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
420
421Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
422Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
423support.
424Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
425Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
426Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
427David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
428Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
429Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
430Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
431Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
432Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
433Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
434Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
435Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
436Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
437Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
438Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
439
440Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
441
442Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
443libraries.
444
445Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
446about several machine instruction sets.
447
448Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
449remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
450contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
451and RDI targets, respectively.
452
453Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
454command-line editing and command history.
455
7a292a7a
SS
456Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
457Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 458
5d161b24 459Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 460He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 461symbols.
c906108c
SS
462
463Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
464Super-H processors.
465
466NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
467
468Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
469
470Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
471
472Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
473
96a2c332 474Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
475
476Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
477watchpoints.
478
479Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
480
481Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
482
483Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 484nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
485
486The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
487support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 488(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
489compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
490John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
491Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
492information in this manual.
493
b37052ae
EZ
494DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
495Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
496
96a2c332
SS
497Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
498development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
499fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
500Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
501Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
502Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
503Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
504addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
505JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
506Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
507Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
508Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
509Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
510Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
511Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
512
513
6d2ebf8b 514@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
515@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
516
517You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
518However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
519debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
520
521@iftex
522In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
523to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
524@end iftex
525
526@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
527@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
528
529One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
530processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
531quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
532definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
533session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
534then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
535same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
536@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
537procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
538
539@smallexample
540$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
541$ @b{./m4}
542@b{define(foo,0000)}
543
544@b{foo}
5450000
546@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
547
548@b{bar}
5490000
550@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
551
552@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
553@b{baz}
554@b{C-d}
555m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
556@end smallexample
557
558@noindent
559Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
560
c906108c
SS
561@smallexample
562$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
563@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
564@c FIXME... format to come out better.
565@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 566 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 567 the conditions.
5d161b24 568There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
569 for details.
570
571@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
572(@value{GDBP})
573@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
574
575@noindent
576@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
577rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
578We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
579that examples fit in this manual.
580
581@smallexample
582(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
583@end smallexample
584
585@noindent
586We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
587Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
588@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
589@code{break} command.
590
591@smallexample
592(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
593Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
594@end smallexample
595
596@noindent
597Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
598control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
599subroutine, the program runs as usual:
600
601@smallexample
602(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
603Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
604@b{define(foo,0000)}
605
606@b{foo}
6070000
608@end smallexample
609
610@noindent
611To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
612suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
613context where it stops.
614
615@smallexample
616@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
617
5d161b24 618Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
619 at builtin.c:879
620879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
625the next line of the current function.
626
627@smallexample
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
630 : nil,
631@end smallexample
632
633@noindent
634@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
635by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
636@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
637subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
638
639@smallexample
640(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
641set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
642 at input.c:530
643530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
644@end smallexample
645
646@noindent
647The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
648suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
649shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
650command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
651in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
652stack frame for each active subroutine.
653
654@smallexample
655(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
656#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
657 at input.c:530
5d161b24 658#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
659 at builtin.c:882
660#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
661#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
662 at macro.c:71
663#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
664#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
665@end smallexample
666
667@noindent
668We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
669times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
670falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
671
672@smallexample
673(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6740x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
675(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6760x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
677def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
678(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
679536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
680 : xstrdup(rq);
681(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
682538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
683@end smallexample
684
685@noindent
686The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
687@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
688and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
689(@code{print}) to see their values.
690
691@smallexample
692(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
693$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
694(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
695$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
696@end smallexample
697
698@noindent
699@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
700To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
701surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
702
703@smallexample
704(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
705533 xfree(rquote);
706534
707535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
708 : xstrdup (lq);
709536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup (rq);
711537
712538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
714540 @}
715541
716542 void
717@end smallexample
718
719@noindent
720Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
721@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
722
723@smallexample
724(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
726(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
727540 @}
728(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
729$3 = 9
730(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
731$4 = 7
732@end smallexample
733
734@noindent
735That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
736@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
737@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
738the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
739any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
740assignments.
741
742@smallexample
743(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
744$5 = 7
745(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
746$6 = 9
747@end smallexample
748
749@noindent
750Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
751@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
752executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
753example that caused trouble initially:
754
755@smallexample
756(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
757Continuing.
758
759@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
760
761baz
7620000
763@end smallexample
764
765@noindent
766Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
767problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
768lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
769
770@smallexample
771@b{C-d}
772Program exited normally.
773@end smallexample
774
775@noindent
776The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
777indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
778session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
779
780@smallexample
781(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
782@end smallexample
c906108c 783
6d2ebf8b 784@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
785@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
786
787This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 788The essentials are:
c906108c 789@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 790@item
53a5351d 791type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 792@item
c906108c
SS
793type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
794@end itemize
795
796@menu
797* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
798* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
799* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
800@end menu
801
6d2ebf8b 802@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
803@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
c906108c
SS
805Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
c906108c
SS
811The command-line options described here are designed
812to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 813options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
814
815The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816specifying an executable program:
817
818@example
819@value{GDBP} @var{program}
820@end example
821
c906108c
SS
822@noindent
823You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824specified:
825
826@example
827@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828@end example
829
830You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831to debug a running process:
832
833@example
834@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835@end example
836
837@noindent
838would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
c906108c 841Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
842complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 846
aa26fa3a
TT
847You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849option processing.
850@example
851gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852@end example
853This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
96a2c332 856You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
857@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859@smallexample
860@value{GDBP} -silent
861@end smallexample
862
863@noindent
864You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867@noindent
868Type
869
870@example
871@value{GDBP} -help
872@end example
873
874@noindent
875to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880@samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883@menu
c906108c
SS
884* File Options:: Choosing files
885* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886@end menu
887
6d2ebf8b 888@node File Options
c906108c
SS
889@subsection Choosing files
890
2df3850c 891When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
892specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
893the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
894@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
895that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
896@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
897that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
898the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
899
900If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
901such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
902argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
903
904Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
905following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
906them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
907(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
908than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
909
d700128c
EZ
910@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
911@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
912@c it.
913
c906108c
SS
914@table @code
915@item -symbols @var{file}
916@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
917@cindex @code{--symbols}
918@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
919Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
920
921@item -exec @var{file}
922@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
923@cindex @code{--exec}
924@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
925Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
926and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
927
928@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 929@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
930Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
931file.
932
c906108c
SS
933@item -core @var{file}
934@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
935@cindex @code{--core}
936@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
937Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
938
939@item -c @var{number}
940Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
941(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
942case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
943
944@item -command @var{file}
945@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
946@cindex @code{--command}
947@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
948Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
949Files,, Command files}.
950
951@item -directory @var{directory}
952@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
953@cindex @code{--directory}
954@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
955Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
956
c906108c
SS
957@item -m
958@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
959@cindex @code{--mapped}
960@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
961@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
962supported on all systems.}@*
963If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 964system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
965to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
966program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 967called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
968Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
969and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
970the symbol table from the executable program.
971
972The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
973is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
974table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 975
c906108c
SS
976@item -r
977@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
978@cindex @code{--readnow}
979@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
980Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
981the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
982This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 983
c906108c
SS
984@end table
985
2df3850c 986You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 987order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
988information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
989on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
990but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
991
992@example
2df3850c 993gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 994@end example
c906108c 995
6d2ebf8b 996@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
997@subsection Choosing modes
998
999You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1000batch mode or quiet mode.
1001
1002@table @code
1003@item -nx
1004@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
1005@cindex @code{--nx}
1006@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 1007Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
1008@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1009options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1010files}.
c906108c
SS
1011
1012@item -quiet
d700128c 1013@itemx -silent
c906108c 1014@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
1015@cindex @code{--quiet}
1016@cindex @code{--silent}
1017@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
1018``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1019messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1020
1021@item -batch
d700128c 1022@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
1023Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1024command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1025initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1026nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1027in the command files.
1028
2df3850c
JM
1029Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1030example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1031make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
1032
1033@example
1034Program exited normally.
1035@end example
1036
1037@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1038(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1039@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1040mode.
1041
1042@item -nowindows
1043@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1044@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1045@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1046``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1047(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1048interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1049
1050@item -windows
1051@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1052@cindex @code{--windows}
1053@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1054If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1055used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1056
1057@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1058@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1059Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1060instead of the current directory.
1061
c906108c
SS
1062@item -fullname
1063@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1064@cindex @code{--fullname}
1065@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1066@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1067subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1068number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1069displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1070recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1071the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1072and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1073@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1074frame.
c906108c 1075
d700128c
EZ
1076@item -epoch
1077@cindex @code{--epoch}
1078The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1079@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1080routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1081separate window.
1082
1083@item -annotate @var{level}
1084@cindex @code{--annotate}
1085This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1086effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1087(@pxref{Annotations}).
1088Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1089together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1090types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1091@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1092maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1093
1094@item -async
1095@cindex @code{--async}
1096Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1097@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1098special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1099commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1100run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1101MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1102suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1103control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1104(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1105operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1106yet.)
1107@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1108@c should be removed.
1109
1110When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1111uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1112@samp{-noasync} option.
1113
1114@item -noasync
1115@cindex @code{--noasync}
1116Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1117
aa26fa3a
TT
1118@item --args
1119@cindex @code{--args}
1120Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1121executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1122This option stops option processing.
1123
2df3850c
JM
1124@item -baud @var{bps}
1125@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1126@cindex @code{--baud}
1127@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1128Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1129interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1130
1131@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1132@itemx -t @var{device}
1133@cindex @code{--tty}
1134@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1135Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1136@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1137
53a5351d 1138@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1139@item -tui
1140@cindex @code{--tui}
1141Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1142The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1143showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1144(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1145Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1146(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1147
1148@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1149@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1150@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1151@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1152@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1153@c systems.
1154
d700128c
EZ
1155@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1156@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1157Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1158program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1159communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1160
1161@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1162@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1163@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1164@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1165
1166@item -write
1167@cindex @code{--write}
1168Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1169is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1170(@pxref{Patching}).
1171
1172@item -statistics
1173@cindex @code{--statistics}
1174This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1175memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1176
1177@item -version
1178@cindex @code{--version}
1179This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1180no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1181
c906108c
SS
1182@end table
1183
6d2ebf8b 1184@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1185@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1186@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1187@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1188
1189@table @code
1190@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1191@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1192@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1193@itemx q
1194To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1195@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1196do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1197otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1198error code.
c906108c
SS
1199@end table
1200
1201@cindex interrupt
1202An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1203terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1204returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1205character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1206until a time when it is safe.
1207
c906108c
SS
1208If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1209device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1210(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1211
6d2ebf8b 1212@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1213@section Shell commands
1214
1215If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1216debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1217just use the @code{shell} command.
1218
1219@table @code
1220@kindex shell
1221@cindex shell escape
1222@item shell @var{command string}
1223Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1224If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1225shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1226(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1227@end table
1228
1229The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1230You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1231@value{GDBN}:
1232
1233@table @code
1234@kindex make
1235@cindex calling make
1236@item make @var{make-args}
1237Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1238arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1239@end table
1240
6d2ebf8b 1241@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1242@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1243
1244You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1245name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1246@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1247key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1248show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1249
1250@menu
1251* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1252* Completion:: Command completion
1253* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1254@end menu
1255
6d2ebf8b 1256@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1257@section Command syntax
1258
1259A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1260how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1261arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1262command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1263step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1264with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1265
1266@cindex abbreviation
1267@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1268unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1269documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1270abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1271equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1272names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1273arguments to the @code{help} command.
1274
1275@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1276@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1277A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1278repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1279will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1280repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1281repeat.
1282
1283The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1284@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1285exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1286
1287@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1288output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1289(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1290@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1291repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1292
41afff9a 1293@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1294@cindex comment
1295Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1296nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1297Files,,Command files}).
1298
88118b3a
TT
1299@cindex repeating command sequences
1300@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1301The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1302commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1303then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1304for editing.
1305
6d2ebf8b 1306@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1307@section Command completion
1308
1309@cindex completion
1310@cindex word completion
1311@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1312only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1313are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1314commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1315
1316Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1317of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1318word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1319enter it). For example, if you type
1320
1321@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1322@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1323@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1324@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1325@example
1326(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1327@end example
1328
1329@noindent
1330@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1331the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1332
1333@example
1334(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1335@end example
1336
1337@noindent
1338You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1339breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1340@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1341were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1342might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1343to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1344
1345If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1346@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1347characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1348@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1349example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1350begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1351just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1352function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1353example:
1354
1355@example
1356(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1357@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1358make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1359make_abs_section make_function_type
1360make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1361make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1362make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1363(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1364@end example
1365
1366@noindent
1367After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1368partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1369command.
1370
1371If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1372can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1373means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1374key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1375one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1376
1377@cindex quotes in commands
1378@cindex completion of quoted strings
1379Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1380parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1381its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1382situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1383@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1384
c906108c 1385The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1386name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1387overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1388by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1389may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1390that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1391that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1392word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1393@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1394@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1395when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1396
1397@example
96a2c332 1398(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1399bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1400(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1401@end example
1402
1403In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1404quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1405completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1406place:
1407
1408@example
1409(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1410@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1411(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1412@end example
1413
1414@noindent
1415In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1416you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1417completion on an overloaded symbol.
1418
d4f3574e 1419For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1420expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1421overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1422see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1423
1424
6d2ebf8b 1425@node Help
c906108c
SS
1426@section Getting help
1427@cindex online documentation
1428@kindex help
1429
5d161b24 1430You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1431using the command @code{help}.
1432
1433@table @code
41afff9a 1434@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1435@item help
1436@itemx h
1437You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1438display a short list of named classes of commands:
1439
1440@smallexample
1441(@value{GDBP}) help
1442List of classes of commands:
1443
2df3850c 1444aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1445breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1446data -- Examining data
c906108c 1447files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1448internals -- Maintenance commands
1449obscure -- Obscure features
1450running -- Running the program
1451stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1452status -- Status inquiries
1453support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1454tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1455 stopping the program
c906108c 1456user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1457
5d161b24 1458Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1459commands in that class.
5d161b24 1460Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1461documentation.
1462Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1463(@value{GDBP})
1464@end smallexample
96a2c332 1465@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1466
1467@item help @var{class}
1468Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1469list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1470help display for the class @code{status}:
1471
1472@smallexample
1473(@value{GDBP}) help status
1474Status inquiries.
1475
1476List of commands:
1477
1478@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1479@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1480info -- Generic command for showing things
1481 about the program being debugged
1482show -- Generic command for showing things
1483 about the debugger
c906108c 1484
5d161b24 1485Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1486documentation.
1487Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1488(@value{GDBP})
1489@end smallexample
1490
1491@item help @var{command}
1492With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1493short paragraph on how to use that command.
1494
6837a0a2
DB
1495@kindex apropos
1496@item apropos @var{args}
1497The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1498commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1499@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1500
1501@smallexample
1502apropos reload
1503@end smallexample
1504
b37052ae
EZ
1505@noindent
1506results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1507
1508@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1509@c @group
1510set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1511 multiple times in one run
1512show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1513 multiple times in one run
1514@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1515@end smallexample
1516
c906108c
SS
1517@kindex complete
1518@item complete @var{args}
1519The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1520for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1521command you want completed. For example:
1522
1523@smallexample
1524complete i
1525@end smallexample
1526
1527@noindent results in:
1528
1529@smallexample
1530@group
2df3850c
JM
1531if
1532ignore
c906108c
SS
1533info
1534inspect
c906108c
SS
1535@end group
1536@end smallexample
1537
1538@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1539@end table
1540
1541In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1542and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1543of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1544manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1545under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1546all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1547
1548@c @group
1549@table @code
1550@kindex info
41afff9a 1551@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1552@item info
1553This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1554program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1555with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1556registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1557You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1558@w{@code{help info}}.
1559
1560@kindex set
1561@item set
5d161b24 1562You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1563@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1564@code{set prompt $}.
1565
1566@kindex show
1567@item show
5d161b24 1568In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1569@value{GDBN} itself.
1570You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1571related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1572system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1573which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1574
1575@kindex info set
1576To display all the settable parameters and their current
1577values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1578@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1579@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1580@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1581@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1582@end table
1583@c @end group
1584
1585Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1586exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1587
1588@table @code
1589@kindex show version
1590@cindex version number
1591@item show version
1592Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1593information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1594@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1595version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1596commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1597system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1598variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1599The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1600@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1601
1602@kindex show copying
1603@item show copying
1604Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1605
1606@kindex show warranty
1607@item show warranty
2df3850c 1608Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1609if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1610
c906108c
SS
1611@end table
1612
6d2ebf8b 1613@node Running
c906108c
SS
1614@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1615
1616When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1617debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1618
1619You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1620of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1621your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1622kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1623
1624@menu
1625* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1626* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1627* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1628* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1629
1630* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1631* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1632* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1633* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1634
1635* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1636* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1637@end menu
1638
6d2ebf8b 1639@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1640@section Compiling for debugging
1641
1642In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1643debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1644is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1645variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1646and addresses in the executable code.
1647
1648To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1649the compiler.
1650
1651Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1652options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1653executables containing debugging information.
1654
53a5351d
JM
1655@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1656without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1657recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1658program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1659in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1660
1661@cindex optimized code, debugging
1662@cindex debugging optimized code
1663When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1664optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1665really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1666exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1667variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1668variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1669
1670Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1671@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1672doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1673please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1674
1675Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1676@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1677format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1678
1679@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1680@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1681@section Starting your program
1682@cindex starting
1683@cindex running
1684
1685@table @code
1686@kindex run
41afff9a 1687@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1688@item run
1689@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1690Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1691You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1692argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1693@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1694(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1695
1696@end table
1697
c906108c
SS
1698If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1699supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1700that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1701@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1702
1703The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1704receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1705information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1706can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1707your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1708divided into four categories:
1709
1710@table @asis
1711@item The @emph{arguments.}
1712Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1713@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1714is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1715(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1716the arguments.
1717In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1718@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1719@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1720
1721@item The @emph{environment.}
1722Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1723use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1724environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1725your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1726
1727@item The @emph{working directory.}
1728Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1729the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1730@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1731
1732@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1733Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1734standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1735in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1736set a different device for your program.
1737@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1738
1739@cindex pipes
1740@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1741pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1742program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1743wrong program.
1744@end table
c906108c
SS
1745
1746When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1747immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1748of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1749stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1750or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1751
1752If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1753time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1754table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1755your current breakpoints.
1756
6d2ebf8b 1757@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1758@section Your program's arguments
1759
1760@cindex arguments (to your program)
1761The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1762@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1763They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1764performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1765@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1766@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1767the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1768
1769On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1770@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1771calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1772the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1773
1774@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1775@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1776
c906108c 1777@table @code
41afff9a 1778@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1779@item set args
1780Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1781@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1782with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1783using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1784it again without arguments.
1785
1786@kindex show args
1787@item show args
1788Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1789@end table
1790
6d2ebf8b 1791@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1792@section Your program's environment
1793
1794@cindex environment (of your program)
1795The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1796their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1797your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1798path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1799the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1800debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1801environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1802
1803@table @code
1804@kindex path
1805@item path @var{directory}
1806Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1807(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1808The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1809You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1810system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1811MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1812is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1813
1814You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1815working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1816use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1817@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1818@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1819@var{directory} to the search path.
1820@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1821@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1822
1823@kindex show paths
1824@item show paths
1825Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1826environment variable).
1827
1828@kindex show environment
1829@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1830Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1831your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1832print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1833your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1834
1835@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1836@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1837Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1838changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1839be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1840any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1841parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1842null value.
1843@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1844@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1845
1846For example, this command:
1847
1848@example
1849set env USER = foo
1850@end example
1851
1852@noindent
d4f3574e 1853tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1854@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1855are not actually required.)
1856
1857@kindex unset environment
1858@item unset environment @var{varname}
1859Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1860program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1861@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1862rather than assigning it an empty value.
1863@end table
1864
d4f3574e
SS
1865@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1866the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1867by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1868@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1869that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1870@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1871your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1872files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1873@file{.profile}.
1874
6d2ebf8b 1875@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1876@section Your program's working directory
1877
1878@cindex working directory (of your program)
1879Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1880working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1881The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1882from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1883working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1884
1885The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1886that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1887specify files}.
1888
1889@table @code
1890@kindex cd
1891@item cd @var{directory}
1892Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1893
1894@kindex pwd
1895@item pwd
1896Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1897@end table
1898
6d2ebf8b 1899@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1900@section Your program's input and output
1901
1902@cindex redirection
1903@cindex i/o
1904@cindex terminal
1905By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1906the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1907to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1908modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1909running your program.
1910
1911@table @code
1912@kindex info terminal
1913@item info terminal
1914Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1915program is using.
1916@end table
1917
1918You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1919redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1920
1921@example
1922run > outfile
1923@end example
1924
1925@noindent
1926starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1927
1928@kindex tty
1929@cindex controlling terminal
1930Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1931with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1932argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1933commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1934process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1935
1936@example
1937tty /dev/ttyb
1938@end example
1939
1940@noindent
1941directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1942default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1943that as their controlling terminal.
1944
1945An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1946effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1947terminal.
1948
1949When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1950command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1951for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1952
6d2ebf8b 1953@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1954@section Debugging an already-running process
1955@kindex attach
1956@cindex attach
1957
1958@table @code
1959@item attach @var{process-id}
1960This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1961outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1962targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1963find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1964or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1965
1966@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1967executing the command.
1968@end table
1969
1970To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1971which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1972programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1973also have permission to send the process a signal.
1974
1975When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1976the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1977the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1978(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1979the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1980Specify Files}.
1981
1982The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1983process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1984with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1985you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1986can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1987process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1988attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1989
1990@table @code
1991@kindex detach
1992@item detach
1993When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1994@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1995the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1996that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1997are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1998@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1999executing the command.
2000@end table
2001
2002If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2003attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2004for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2005control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2006confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2007messages}).
2008
6d2ebf8b 2009@node Kill Process
c906108c 2010@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
2011
2012@table @code
2013@kindex kill
2014@item kill
2015Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2016@end table
2017
2018This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2019running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2020is running.
2021
2022On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2023while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2024@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2025outside the debugger.
2026
2027The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2028relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2029executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2030next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2031reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2032breakpoint settings).
2033
6d2ebf8b 2034@node Threads
c906108c 2035@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2036
2037@cindex threads of execution
2038@cindex multiple threads
2039@cindex switching threads
2040In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2041may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2042of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2043the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2044that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2045modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2046registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2047
2048@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2049programs:
2050
2051@itemize @bullet
2052@item automatic notification of new threads
2053@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2054@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2055@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2056a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2057@item thread-specific breakpoints
2058@end itemize
2059
c906108c
SS
2060@quotation
2061@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2062@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2063If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2064effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2065from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2066like this:
2067
2068@smallexample
2069(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2070(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2071Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2072see the IDs of currently known threads.
2073@end smallexample
2074@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2075@c doesn't support threads"?
2076@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2077
2078@cindex focus of debugging
2079@cindex current thread
2080The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2081threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2082control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2083This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2084program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2085
41afff9a 2086@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2087@cindex thread identifier (system)
2088@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2089@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2090@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2091Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2092the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2093form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2094whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2095LynxOS, you might see
2096
2097@example
2098[New process 35 thread 27]
2099@end example
2100
2101@noindent
2102when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2103the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2104further qualifier.
2105
2106@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2107@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2108@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2109@c program?
2110@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2111@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2112@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2113
2114@cindex thread number
2115@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2116For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2117number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2118
2119@table @code
2120@kindex info threads
2121@item info threads
2122Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2123program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2124
2125@enumerate
2126@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2127
2128@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2129
2130@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2131@end enumerate
2132
2133@noindent
2134An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2135indicates the current thread.
2136
5d161b24 2137For example,
c906108c
SS
2138@end table
2139@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2140
2141@smallexample
2142(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2143 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2144 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2145* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2146 at threadtest.c:68
2147@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2148
2149On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@cindex thread number
2152@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2153For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2154number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2155thread in your program.
2156
41afff9a
EZ
2157@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2158@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2159@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2160@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2161@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2162Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2163both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2164form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2165whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2166HP-UX, you see
2167
2168@example
2169[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2170@end example
2171
2172@noindent
5d161b24 2173when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2174
2175@table @code
2176@kindex info threads
2177@item info threads
2178Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2179program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2180
2181@enumerate
2182@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2183
2184@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2185
2186@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2187@end enumerate
2188
2189@noindent
2190An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2191indicates the current thread.
2192
5d161b24 2193For example,
c906108c
SS
2194@end table
2195@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2196
2197@example
2198(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2199 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2200 at quicksort.c:137
2201 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2202 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2203 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2204 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2205@end example
c906108c
SS
2206
2207@table @code
2208@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2209@item thread @var{threadno}
2210Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2211argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2212shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2213@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2214you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2215
2216@smallexample
2217@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2218(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2219[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
22200x34e5 in sigpause ()
2221@end smallexample
2222
2223@noindent
2224As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2225@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2226threads.
c906108c
SS
2227
2228@kindex thread apply
2229@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2230The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2231more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2232with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2233@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2234threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2235@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2236@end table
2237
2238@cindex automatic thread selection
2239@cindex switching threads automatically
2240@cindex threads, automatic switching
2241Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2242signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2243signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2244message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2245thread.
2246
2247@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2248more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2249programs with multiple threads.
2250
2251@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2252watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2253
6d2ebf8b 2254@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2255@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2256
2257@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2258@cindex multiple processes
2259@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2260On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2261programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2262function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2263parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2264set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2265will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2266will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2267
2268However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2269which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2270the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2271only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2272so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2273on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2274get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2275@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2276the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2277the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2278
53a5351d
JM
2279On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2280debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2281@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2282
2283By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2284the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2285
2286If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2287use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2288
2289@table @code
2290@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2291@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2292Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2293@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2294process. The @var{mode} can be:
2295
2296@table @code
2297@item parent
2298The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2299unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2300
2301@item child
2302The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2303unimpeded.
2304
2305@item ask
2306The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2307@end table
2308
2309@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2310Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2311@end table
2312
2313If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2314@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2315breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2316@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2317the child process's @code{main}.
2318
2319When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2320child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2321
2322If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2323call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2324use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2325argument.
2326
2327You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2328a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2329Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2330
6d2ebf8b 2331@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2332@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2333
2334The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2335program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2336trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2337
7a292a7a
SS
2338Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2339such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2340@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2341change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2342continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2343ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2344explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2345
2346@table @code
2347@kindex info program
2348@item info program
2349Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2350running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2351@end table
2352
2353@menu
2354* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2355* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2356* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2357* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2358@end menu
2359
6d2ebf8b 2360@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2361@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2362
2363@cindex breakpoints
2364A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2365the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2366control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2367breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2368Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2369should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2370program.
2371
2372In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2373breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2374a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2375is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2376not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2377arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2378
2379@cindex watchpoints
2380@cindex memory tracing
2381@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2382@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2383A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2384when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2385command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2386watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2387any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2388and watchpoints using the same commands.
2389
2390You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2391whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2392Automatic display}.
2393
2394@cindex catchpoints
2395@cindex breakpoint on events
2396A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2397when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2398exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2399different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2400catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2401other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2402@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2403
2404@cindex breakpoint numbers
2405@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2406@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2407catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2408starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2409features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2410breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2411@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2412enable it again.
2413
c5394b80
JM
2414@cindex breakpoint ranges
2415@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2416Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2417operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2418@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2419hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2420all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2421
c906108c
SS
2422@menu
2423* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2424* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2425* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2426* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2427* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2428* Conditions:: Break conditions
2429* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2430* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2431* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2432@end menu
2433
6d2ebf8b 2434@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2435@subsection Setting breakpoints
2436
5d161b24 2437@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2438@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2439@c
2440@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2441
2442@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2443@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2444@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2445@cindex latest breakpoint
2446Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2447@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2448number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2449Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2450convenience variables.
2451
2452You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2453
2454@table @code
2455@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2456Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2457When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2458C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2459@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2460
2461@item break +@var{offset}
2462@itemx break -@var{offset}
2463Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2464at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2465(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2466
2467@item break @var{linenum}
2468Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2469The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2470The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2471code on that line.
2472
2473@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2474Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2475
2476@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2477Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2478@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2479superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2480functions.
2481
2482@item break *@var{address}
2483Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2484breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2485information or source files.
2486
2487@item break
2488When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2489the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2490(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2491innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2492returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2493@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2494that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2495@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2496the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2497inside loops.
2498
2499@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2500least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2501would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2502breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2503existed when your program stopped.
2504
2505@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2506Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2507@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2508value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2509@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2510above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2511,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2512
2513@kindex tbreak
2514@item tbreak @var{args}
2515Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2516same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2517way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2518program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2519
c906108c
SS
2520@kindex hbreak
2521@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2522Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2523@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2524breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2525have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2526debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2527changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2528provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2529will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2530address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2531breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2532example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2533@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2534or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2535(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2536
2537@kindex thbreak
2538@item thbreak @var{args}
2539Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2540are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2541the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2542the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2543first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2544command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2545may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2546See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2547
2548@kindex rbreak
2549@cindex regular expression
2550@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2551Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2552@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2553matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2554breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2555the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2556them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2557
2558The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2559like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2560shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2561an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2562@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2563match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2564
b37052ae 2565When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2566breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2567classes.
c906108c
SS
2568
2569@kindex info breakpoints
2570@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2571@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2572@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2573@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2574Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2575not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2576
2577@table @emph
2578@item Breakpoint Numbers
2579@item Type
2580Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2581@item Disposition
2582Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2583@item Enabled or Disabled
2584Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2585that are not enabled.
2586@item Address
2df3850c 2587Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2588@item What
2589Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2590line number.
2591@end table
2592
2593@noindent
2594If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2595the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2596are listed after that.
2597
2598@noindent
2599@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2600number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2601convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2602the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2603listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2604
2605@noindent
2606@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2607has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2608@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2609hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2610was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2611will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2612@end table
2613
2614@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2615your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2616the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2617(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2618
2619@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2620@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2621@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2622purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2623These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2624@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2625
2626You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2627@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2628
2629@table @code
2630@kindex maint info breakpoints
2631@item maint info breakpoints
2632Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2633breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2634internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2635breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2636is shown:
2637
2638@table @code
2639@item breakpoint
2640Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2641
2642@item watchpoint
2643Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2644
2645@item longjmp
2646Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2647@code{longjmp} calls.
2648
2649@item longjmp resume
2650Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2651
2652@item until
2653Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2654
2655@item finish
2656Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2657
c906108c
SS
2658@item shlib events
2659Shared library events.
53a5351d 2660
c906108c 2661@end table
53a5351d 2662
c906108c
SS
2663@end table
2664
2665
6d2ebf8b 2666@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2667@subsection Setting watchpoints
2668
2669@cindex setting watchpoints
2670@cindex software watchpoints
2671@cindex hardware watchpoints
2672You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2673expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2674this may happen.
2675
2676Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2677hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2678program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2679times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2680catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2681culprit.)
2682
d4f3574e 2683On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2684@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2685hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2686program.
2687
2688@table @code
2689@kindex watch
2690@item watch @var{expr}
2691Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2692is written into by the program and its value changes.
2693
2694@kindex rwatch
2695@item rwatch @var{expr}
2696Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2697
2698@kindex awatch
2699@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2700Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2701by the program.
c906108c
SS
2702
2703@kindex info watchpoints
2704@item info watchpoints
2705This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2706it is the same as @code{info break}.
2707@end table
2708
2709@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2710watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2711value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2712cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2713executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2714statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2715
2716When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2717
2718@example
2719Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2720@end example
2721
2722@noindent
2723if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2724
7be570e7
JM
2725Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2726hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2727value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2728every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2729that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2730hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2731will print a message like this:
2732
2733@smallexample
2734Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2735@end smallexample
2736
2737Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2738data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2739watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2740can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2741cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2742double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2743wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2744into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2745
2746If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2747to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2748Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2749time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2750able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2751warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2752
2753@smallexample
2754Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2755@end smallexample
2756
2757@noindent
2758If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2759
2760The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2761or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2762data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2763hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2764both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2765watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2766@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2767watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2768@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2769Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2770
2771If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2772any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2773kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2774
7be570e7
JM
2775@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2776(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2777they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2778which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2779being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2780and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2781rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2782way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2783@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2784
c906108c
SS
2785@quotation
2786@cindex watchpoints and threads
2787@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2788@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2789usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2790can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2791you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2792thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2793can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2794@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2795the expression.
53a5351d 2796
d4f3574e 2797@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2798@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2799have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2800watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2801single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2802change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2803confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2804software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2805when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2806watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2807@end quotation
c906108c 2808
6d2ebf8b 2809@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2810@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2811@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2812@cindex exception handlers
2813@cindex event handling
2814
2815You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2816kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2817shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2818
2819@table @code
2820@kindex catch
2821@item catch @var{event}
2822Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2823@table @code
2824@item throw
2825@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2826The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2827
2828@item catch
2829@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2830The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2831
2832@item exec
2833@kindex catch exec
2834A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2835
2836@item fork
2837@kindex catch fork
2838A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2839
2840@item vfork
2841@kindex catch vfork
2842A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2843
2844@item load
2845@itemx load @var{libname}
2846@kindex catch load
2847The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2848@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2849
2850@item unload
2851@itemx unload @var{libname}
2852@kindex catch unload
2853The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2854of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2855@end table
2856
2857@item tcatch @var{event}
2858Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2859automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2860
2861@end table
2862
2863Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2864
b37052ae 2865There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2866(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2867
2868@itemize @bullet
2869@item
2870If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2871control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2872raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2873returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2874simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2875that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2876you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2877disabled within interactive calls.
2878
2879@item
2880You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2881
2882@item
2883You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2884@end itemize
2885
2886@cindex raise exceptions
2887Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2888if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2889stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2890can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2891breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2892out where the exception was raised.
2893
2894To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2895knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2896raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2897which has the following ANSI C interface:
2898
2899@example
2900 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2901 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2902 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2903@end example
2904
2905@noindent
2906To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2907unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2908(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2909
2910With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2911that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2912a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2913breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2914raised.
2915
2916
6d2ebf8b 2917@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2918@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2919
2920@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2921@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2922It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2923catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2924to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2925breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2926
2927With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2928where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2929delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2930their breakpoint numbers.
2931
2932It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2933automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2934when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2935
2936@table @code
2937@kindex clear
2938@item clear
2939Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2940selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2941the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2942breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2943
2944@item clear @var{function}
2945@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2946Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2947
2948@item clear @var{linenum}
2949@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2950Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2951
2952@cindex delete breakpoints
2953@kindex delete
41afff9a 2954@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2955@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2956Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2957ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2958breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2959confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2960@end table
2961
6d2ebf8b 2962@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2963@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2964
2965@kindex disable breakpoints
2966@kindex enable breakpoints
2967Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2968prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2969it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2970that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2971
2972You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2973the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2974or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2975@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2976catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2977
2978A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2979states of enablement:
2980
2981@itemize @bullet
2982@item
2983Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2984with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2985@item
2986Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2987@item
2988Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2989disabled.
c906108c
SS
2990@item
2991Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2992immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2993set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2994@end itemize
2995
2996You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2997watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2998
2999@table @code
3000@kindex disable breakpoints
3001@kindex disable
41afff9a 3002@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 3003@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
3004Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3005listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3006options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3007case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3008@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3009
3010@kindex enable breakpoints
3011@kindex enable
c5394b80 3012@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
3013Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3014become effective once again in stopping your program.
3015
c5394b80 3016@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
3017Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3018of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3019
c5394b80 3020@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
3021Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3022deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3023@end table
3024
d4f3574e
SS
3025@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3026@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
3027Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3028,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3029subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3030the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3031breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3032breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3033stepping}.)
3034
6d2ebf8b 3035@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
3036@subsection Break conditions
3037@cindex conditional breakpoints
3038@cindex breakpoint conditions
3039
3040@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 3041@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
3042The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3043specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3044breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3045programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3046a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3047and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3048
3049This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3050situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3051when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3052by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3053@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3054
3055Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3056since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3057it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3058and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3059one.
3060
3061Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3062your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3063that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3064format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3065unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3066that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3067program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3068breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3069conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3070purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3071(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3072
3073Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3074@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3075Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3076with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3077
c906108c
SS
3078You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3079The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3080@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3081catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3082
3083@table @code
3084@kindex condition
3085@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3086Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3087watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3088breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3089@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3090@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3091syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3092referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3093symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3094prints an error message:
3095
3096@example
3097No symbol "foo" in current context.
3098@end example
3099
3100@noindent
c906108c
SS
3101@value{GDBN} does
3102not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3103command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3104@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3105
3106@item condition @var{bnum}
3107Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3108an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3109@end table
3110
3111@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3112A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3113breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3114useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3115count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3116is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3117therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3118ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3119the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3120value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3121your program reaches it.
3122
3123@table @code
3124@kindex ignore
3125@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3126Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3127The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3128execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3129takes no action.
3130
3131To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3132a count of zero.
3133
3134When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3135breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3136@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3137Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3138
3139If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3140condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3141@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3142
3143You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3144as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3145is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3146variables}.
3147@end table
3148
3149Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3150
3151
6d2ebf8b 3152@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3153@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3154
3155@cindex breakpoint commands
3156You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3157commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3158example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3159enable other breakpoints.
3160
3161@table @code
3162@kindex commands
3163@kindex end
3164@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3165@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3166@itemx end
3167Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3168themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3169@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3170
3171To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3172follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3173
3174With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3175breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3176recently encountered).
3177@end table
3178
3179Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3180disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3181
3182You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3183use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3184that resumes execution.
3185
3186Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3187execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3188(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3189another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3190ambiguities about which list to execute.
3191
3192@kindex silent
3193If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3194usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3195be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3196then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3197see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3198meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3199
3200The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3201print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3202breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3203
3204For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3205value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3206
3207@example
3208break foo if x>0
3209commands
3210silent
3211printf "x is %d\n",x
3212cont
3213end
3214@end example
3215
3216One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3217you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3218of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3219erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3220to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3221so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3222command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3223
3224@example
3225break 403
3226commands
3227silent
3228set x = y + 4
3229cont
3230end
3231@end example
3232
6d2ebf8b 3233@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3234@subsection Breakpoint menus
3235@cindex overloading
3236@cindex symbol overloading
3237
b37052ae 3238Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3239to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3240This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3241@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3242a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3243something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3244particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3245you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3246waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3247options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3248sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3249@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3250breakpoints.
3251
3252For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3253breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3254We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3255
3256@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3257@smallexample
3258@group
3259(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3260[0] cancel
3261[1] all
3262[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3263[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3264[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3265[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3266[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3267[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3268> 2 4 6
3269Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3270Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3271Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3272Multiple breakpoints were set.
3273Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3274 breakpoints.
3275(@value{GDBP})
3276@end group
3277@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3278
3279@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3280@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3281@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3282@c
3283@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3284@c
d4f3574e
SS
3285Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3286any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3287attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3288@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3289
3290@example
3291Cannot insert breakpoints.
3292The same program may be running in another process.
3293@end example
3294
3295When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3296
3297@enumerate
3298@item
3299Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3300
3301@item
5d161b24 3302Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3303name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3304that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3305Then start your program again.
3306
3307@item
3308Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3309linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3310to nonsharable executables.
3311@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3312@c @end ifclear
3313
d4f3574e
SS
3314A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3315hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3316
3317@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3318@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3319@smallexample
3320Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3321You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3322@end smallexample
3323
3324@noindent
3325This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3326only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3327watchpoints it needs to insert.
3328
3329When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3330hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3331
3332
6d2ebf8b 3333@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3334@section Continuing and stepping
3335
3336@cindex stepping
3337@cindex continuing
3338@cindex resuming execution
3339@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3340completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3341one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3342line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3343particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3344your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3345it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3346@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3347
3348@table @code
3349@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3350@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3351@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3352@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3353@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3354@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3355Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3356any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3357@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3358ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3359@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3360
3361The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3362stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3363@code{continue} is ignored.
3364
d4f3574e
SS
3365The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3366debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3367purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3368@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3369@end table
3370
3371To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3372(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3373calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3374different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3375
3376A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3377(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3378beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3379is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3380and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3381interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3382
3383@table @code
3384@kindex step
41afff9a 3385@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3386@item step
3387Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3388line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3389abbreviated @code{s}.
3390
3391@quotation
3392@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3393@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3394@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3395@c distinction here.
3396@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3397within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3398execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3399debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3400is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3401without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3402below.
3403@end quotation
3404
4a92d011
EZ
3405The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3406line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3407@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3408to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3409the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3410called within the line.
c906108c 3411
d4f3574e
SS
3412Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3413number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3414@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3415on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3416was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3417
3418@item step @var{count}
3419Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3420breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3421@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3422
3423@kindex next
41afff9a 3424@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3425@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3426Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3427This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3428the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3429control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3430that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3431is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3432
3433An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3434
3435
3436@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3437@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3438@c
3439@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3440@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3441@c function are executed without stopping.
3442
d4f3574e
SS
3443The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3444source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3445@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3446
b90a5f51
CF
3447@kindex set step-mode
3448@item set step-mode
3449@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3450@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3451@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3452The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3453stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3454information rather than stepping over it.
3455
4a92d011
EZ
3456This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3457machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3458want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3459
3460@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3461Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3462debug information. This is the default.
3463
c906108c
SS
3464@kindex finish
3465@item finish
3466Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3467returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3468
3469Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3470,Returning from a function}).
3471
3472@kindex until
41afff9a 3473@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3474@item until
3475@itemx u
3476Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3477current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3478stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3479command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3480automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3481than the address of the jump.
3482
3483This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3484though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3485exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3486simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3487through the next iteration.
3488
3489@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3490stack frame.
3491
3492@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3493of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3494example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3495(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3496@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3497
3498@example
3499(@value{GDBP}) f
3500#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3501206 expand_input();
3502(@value{GDBP}) until
3503195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3504@end example
3505
3506This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3507generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3508start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3509written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3510to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3511expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3512statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3513
3514@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3515instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3516argument.
3517
3518@item until @var{location}
3519@itemx u @var{location}
3520Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3521reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3522the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3523,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3524and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3525
3526@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3527@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3528@item stepi
96a2c332 3529@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3530@itemx si
3531Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3532
3533It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3534instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3535instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3536Display,, Automatic display}.
3537
3538An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3539
3540@need 750
3541@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3542@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3543@item nexti
96a2c332 3544@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3545@itemx ni
3546Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3547proceed until the function returns.
3548
3549An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3550@end table
3551
6d2ebf8b 3552@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3553@section Signals
3554@cindex signals
3555
3556A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3557operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3558kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3559signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3560@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3561memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3562the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3563requested an alarm).
3564
3565@cindex fatal signals
3566Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3567functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3568errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3569program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3570@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3571fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3572
3573@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3574program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3575signal.
3576
3577@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3578Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3579@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3580(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3581but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3582You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3583
3584@table @code
3585@kindex info signals
3586@item info signals
96a2c332 3587@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3588Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3589handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3590the defined types of signals.
3591
d4f3574e 3592@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3593
3594@kindex handle
3595@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3596Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3597can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3598@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3599@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3600known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3601@end table
3602
3603@c @group
3604The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3605Their full names are:
3606
3607@table @code
3608@item nostop
3609@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3610still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3611
3612@item stop
3613@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3614the @code{print} keyword as well.
3615
3616@item print
3617@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3618
3619@item noprint
3620@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3621implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3622
3623@item pass
5ece1a18 3624@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3625@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3626can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3627and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3628
3629@item nopass
5ece1a18 3630@itemx ignore
c906108c 3631@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3632@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3633@end table
3634@c @end group
3635
d4f3574e
SS
3636When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3637program until you
c906108c
SS
3638continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3639effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3640after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3641command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3642program sees that signal when you continue.
3643
24f93129
EZ
3644The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3645non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3646@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3647erroneous signals.
3648
c906108c
SS
3649You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3650seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3651or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3652due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3653values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3654execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3655a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3656you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3657program a signal}.
c906108c 3658
6d2ebf8b 3659@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3660@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3661
3662When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3663programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3664breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3665
3666@table @code
3667@cindex breakpoints and threads
3668@cindex thread breakpoints
3669@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3670@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3671@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3672@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3673writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3674
3675Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3676to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3677particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3678numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3679column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3680
3681If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3682breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3683program.
3684
3685You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3686well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3687breakpoint condition, like this:
3688
3689@smallexample
2df3850c 3690(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3691@end smallexample
3692
3693@end table
3694
3695@cindex stopped threads
3696@cindex threads, stopped
3697Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3698@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3699allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3700switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3701underfoot.
3702
3703@cindex continuing threads
3704@cindex threads, continuing
3705Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3706executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3707like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3708
3709In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3710Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3711system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3712execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3713single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3714statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3715stops.
3716
3717You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3718continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3719thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3720first thread completes whatever you requested.
3721
3722On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3723thread to run.
3724
3725@table @code
3726@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3727Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3728locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3729current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3730mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3731``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3732stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3733when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3734function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3735like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3736thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3737@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3738
3739@item show scheduler-locking
3740Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3741@end table
3742
c906108c 3743
6d2ebf8b 3744@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3745@chapter Examining the Stack
3746
3747When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3748stopped and how it got there.
3749
3750@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3751Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3752is generated.
3753That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3754the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3755and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3756The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3757The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3758stack}.
3759
3760When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3761stack allow you to see all of this information.
3762
3763@cindex selected frame
3764One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3765@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3766particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3767your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3768special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3769interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3770
3771When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3772currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3773@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3774
3775@menu
3776* Frames:: Stack frames
3777* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3778* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3779* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3780
3781@end menu
3782
6d2ebf8b 3783@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3784@section Stack frames
3785
d4f3574e 3786@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3787@cindex stack frame
3788The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3789frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3790with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3791to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3792which the function is executing.
3793
3794@cindex initial frame
3795@cindex outermost frame
3796@cindex innermost frame
3797When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3798function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3799@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3800made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3801is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3802the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3803actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3804recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3805
3806@cindex frame pointer
3807Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3808stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3809kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3810address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3811in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3812going on in that frame.
3813
3814@cindex frame number
3815@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3816zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3817and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3818they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3819frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3820
6d2ebf8b
SS
3821@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3822@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3823@cindex frameless execution
3824Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3825without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3826@example
3827@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3828@end example
3829generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3830This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3831the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3832with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3833has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3834it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3835correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3836no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3837
3838@table @code
d4f3574e 3839@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3840@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3841@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3842The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3843and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3844address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3845@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3846
3847@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3848@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3849@item select-frame
3850The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3851to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3852@code{frame}.
3853@end table
3854
6d2ebf8b 3855@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3856@section Backtraces
3857
3858@cindex backtraces
3859@cindex tracebacks
3860@cindex stack traces
3861A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3862line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3863frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3864stack.
3865
3866@table @code
3867@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3868@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3869@item backtrace
3870@itemx bt
3871Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3872frames in the stack.
3873
3874You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3875character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3876
3877@item backtrace @var{n}
3878@itemx bt @var{n}
3879Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3880
3881@item backtrace -@var{n}
3882@itemx bt -@var{n}
3883Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3884@end table
3885
3886@kindex where
3887@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3888@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3889The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3890are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3891
3892Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3893The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3894print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3895line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3896counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3897line number.
3898
3899Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3900@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3901
3902@smallexample
3903@group
5d161b24 3904#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3905 at builtin.c:993
3906#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3907#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3908 at macro.c:71
3909(More stack frames follow...)
3910@end group
3911@end smallexample
3912
3913@noindent
3914The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3915value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3916code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3917
6d2ebf8b 3918@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3919@section Selecting a frame
3920
3921Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3922whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3923selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3924of the stack frame just selected.
3925
3926@table @code
d4f3574e 3927@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3928@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3929@item frame @var{n}
3930@itemx f @var{n}
3931Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3932(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3933innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3934@code{main}.
3935
3936@item frame @var{addr}
3937@itemx f @var{addr}
3938Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3939chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3940impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3941addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3942switches between them.
3943
c906108c
SS
3944On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3945select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3946
3947On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3948pointer and a program counter.
3949
3950On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3951pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3952@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3953@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3954@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3955
3956@kindex up
3957@item up @var{n}
3958Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3959advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3960that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3961
3962@kindex down
41afff9a 3963@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3964@item down @var{n}
3965Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3966advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3967that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3968abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3969@end table
3970
3971All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3972frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3973arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3974frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3975
3976@need 1000
3977For example:
3978
3979@smallexample
3980@group
3981(@value{GDBP}) up
3982#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3983 at env.c:10
398410 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3985@end group
3986@end smallexample
3987
3988After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3989prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3990@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3991
3992@table @code
3993@kindex down-silently
3994@kindex up-silently
3995@item up-silently @var{n}
3996@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3997These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3998respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3999causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4000in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4001distracting.
4002@end table
4003
6d2ebf8b 4004@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
4005@section Information about a frame
4006
4007There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4008stack frame.
4009
4010@table @code
4011@item frame
4012@itemx f
4013When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4014frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4015selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4016argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4017@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4018
4019@kindex info frame
41afff9a 4020@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
4021@item info frame
4022@itemx info f
4023This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4024including:
4025
4026@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
4027@item
4028the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
4029@item
4030the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4031@item
4032the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4033@item
4034the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4035@item
4036the address of the frame's arguments
4037@item
d4f3574e
SS
4038the address of the frame's local variables
4039@item
c906108c
SS
4040the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4041@item
4042which registers were saved in the frame
4043@end itemize
4044
4045@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4046something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4047the usual conventions.
4048
4049@item info frame @var{addr}
4050@itemx info f @var{addr}
4051Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4052selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4053command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4054architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4055@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4056
4057@kindex info args
4058@item info args
4059Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4060
4061@item info locals
4062@kindex info locals
4063Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4064line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4065accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4066
c906108c 4067@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4068@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4069@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4070@item info catch
4071Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4072current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4073exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4074@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4075@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4076
c906108c
SS
4077@end table
4078
c906108c 4079
6d2ebf8b 4080@node Source
c906108c
SS
4081@chapter Examining Source Files
4082
4083@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4084information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4085used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4086the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4087(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4088execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4089source files by explicit command.
4090
7a292a7a 4091If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4092prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4093@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4094
4095@menu
4096* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 4097* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4098* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4099* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4100@end menu
4101
6d2ebf8b 4102@node List
c906108c
SS
4103@section Printing source lines
4104
4105@kindex list
41afff9a 4106@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4107To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4108(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4109There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4110
4111Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4112
4113@table @code
4114@item list @var{linenum}
4115Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4116current source file.
4117
4118@item list @var{function}
4119Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4120@var{function}.
4121
4122@item list
4123Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4124@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4125printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4126as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4127Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4128
4129@item list -
4130Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4131@end table
4132
4133By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4134the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4135
4136@table @code
4137@kindex set listsize
4138@item set listsize @var{count}
4139Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4140the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4141
4142@kindex show listsize
4143@item show listsize
4144Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4145@end table
4146
4147Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4148so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4149than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4150argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4151each repetition moves up in the source file.
4152
4153@cindex linespec
4154In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4155@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4156of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4157Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4158
4159@table @code
4160@item list @var{linespec}
4161Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4162
4163@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4164Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4165linespecs.
4166
4167@item list ,@var{last}
4168Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4169
4170@item list @var{first},
4171Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4172
4173@item list +
4174Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4175
4176@item list -
4177Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4178
4179@item list
4180As described in the preceding table.
4181@end table
4182
4183Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4184kinds of linespec.
4185
4186@table @code
4187@item @var{number}
4188Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4189When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4190the same source file as the first linespec.
4191
4192@item +@var{offset}
4193Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4194When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4195two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4196first linespec.
4197
4198@item -@var{offset}
4199Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4200
4201@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4202Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4203
4204@item @var{function}
4205Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4206For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4207
4208@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4209Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4210function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4211file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4212identically named functions in different source files.
4213
4214@item *@var{address}
4215Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4216@var{address} may be any expression.
4217@end table
4218
6d2ebf8b 4219@node Search
c906108c
SS
4220@section Searching source files
4221@cindex searching
4222@kindex reverse-search
4223
4224There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4225regular expression.
4226
4227@table @code
4228@kindex search
4229@kindex forward-search
4230@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4231@itemx search @var{regexp}
4232The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4233starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4234@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4235synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4236@code{fo}.
4237
4238@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4239The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4240with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4241for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4242this command as @code{rev}.
4243@end table
c906108c 4244
6d2ebf8b 4245@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4246@section Specifying source directories
4247
4248@cindex source path
4249@cindex directories for source files
4250Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4251files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4252the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4253session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4254this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4255it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4256in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4257the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4258the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4259path.
4260
4261If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4262object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4263too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4264compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4265last resort.
4266
4267Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4268any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4269each line is in the file.
4270
4271@kindex directory
4272@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4273When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4274and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4275To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4276
4277@table @code
4278@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4279@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4280Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4281directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4282(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4283part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4284whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4285path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4286
4287@kindex cdir
4288@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4289@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4290@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4291@cindex compilation directory
4292@cindex current directory
4293@cindex working directory
4294@cindex directory, current
4295@cindex directory, compilation
4296You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4297directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4298working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4299tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4300session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4301directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4302
4303@item directory
4304Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4305
4306@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4307@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4308
4309@item show directories
4310@kindex show directories
4311Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4312@end table
4313
4314If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4315interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4316versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4317
4318@enumerate
4319@item
4320Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4321
4322@item
4323Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4324directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4325directories in one command.
4326@end enumerate
4327
6d2ebf8b 4328@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4329@section Source and machine code
4330
4331You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4332addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4333a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4334mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4335line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4336well as hex.
4337
4338@table @code
4339@kindex info line
4340@item info line @var{linespec}
4341Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4342source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4343the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4344source lines}).
4345@end table
4346
4347For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4348the object code for the first line of function
4349@code{m4_changequote}:
4350
d4f3574e
SS
4351@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4352@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4353@smallexample
96a2c332 4354(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4355Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4356@end smallexample
4357
4358@noindent
4359We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4360@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4361@smallexample
4362(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4363Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4364@end smallexample
4365
4366@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4367@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4368After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4369is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4370sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4371,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4372convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4373variables}).
4374
4375@table @code
4376@kindex disassemble
4377@cindex assembly instructions
4378@cindex instructions, assembly
4379@cindex machine instructions
4380@cindex listing machine instructions
4381@item disassemble
4382This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4383instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4384program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4385command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4386surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4387(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4388@end table
4389
c906108c
SS
4390The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4391HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4392
4393@smallexample
4394(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4395Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
43960x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
43970x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
43980x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
43990x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44000x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44010x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44020x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44030x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4404End of assembler dump.
4405@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4406
4407Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4408mnemonics or other syntax.
4409
4410@table @code
d4f3574e 4411@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4412@cindex assembly instructions
4413@cindex instructions, assembly
4414@cindex machine instructions
4415@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4416@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4417@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4418@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4419Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4420program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4421
4422Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4423can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4424The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4425assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4426@end table
4427
4428
6d2ebf8b 4429@node Data
c906108c
SS
4430@chapter Examining Data
4431
4432@cindex printing data
4433@cindex examining data
4434@kindex print
4435@kindex inspect
4436@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4437@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4438@c different window or something like that.
4439The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4440command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4441evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4442program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4443Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4444
4445@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4446@item print @var{expr}
4447@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4448@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4449value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4450you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4451@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4452formats}.
4453
4454@item print
4455@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4456If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4457@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4458conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4459@end table
4460
4461A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4462It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4463specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4464
7a292a7a 4465If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4466fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4467command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4468Table}.
c906108c
SS
4469
4470@menu
4471* Expressions:: Expressions
4472* Variables:: Program variables
4473* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4474* Output Formats:: Output formats
4475* Memory:: Examining memory
4476* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4477* Print Settings:: Print settings
4478* Value History:: Value history
4479* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4480* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4481* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4482* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4483@end menu
4484
6d2ebf8b 4485@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4486@section Expressions
4487
4488@cindex expressions
4489@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4490compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4491by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4492@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4493and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4494by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4495
d4f3574e
SS
4496@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4497the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4498you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4499memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4500
c906108c
SS
4501Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4502this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4503Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4504languages.
4505
4506In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4507expressions regardless of your programming language.
4508
4509Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4510useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4511at that address in memory.
4512@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4513
4514@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4515to programming languages:
4516
4517@table @code
4518@item @@
4519@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4520@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4521
4522@item ::
4523@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4524function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4525
4526@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4527@cindex type casting memory
4528@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4529@cindex casts, to view memory
4530@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4531Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4532memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4533pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4534a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4535normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4536@end table
4537
6d2ebf8b 4538@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4539@section Program variables
4540
4541The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4542in your program.
4543
4544Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4545(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4546
4547@itemize @bullet
4548@item
4549global (or file-static)
4550@end itemize
4551
5d161b24 4552@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4553
4554@itemize @bullet
4555@item
4556visible according to the scope rules of the
4557programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4558@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4559
4560@noindent This means that in the function
4561
4562@example
4563foo (a)
4564 int a;
4565@{
4566 bar (a);
4567 @{
4568 int b = test ();
4569 bar (b);
4570 @}
4571@}
4572@end example
4573
4574@noindent
4575you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4576executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4577examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4578the block where @code{b} is declared.
4579
4580@cindex variable name conflict
4581There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4582scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4583in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4584function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4585happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4586you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4587using the colon-colon notation:
4588
d4f3574e 4589@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4590@iftex
4591@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4592@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4593@end iftex
4594@example
4595@var{file}::@var{variable}
4596@var{function}::@var{variable}
4597@end example
4598
4599@noindent
4600Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4601static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4602make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4603to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4604
4605@example
4606(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4607@end example
4608
b37052ae 4609@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4610This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4611use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4612scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4613@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4614@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4615
4616@cindex wrong values
4617@cindex variable values, wrong
4618@quotation
4619@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4620wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4621scope, and just before exit.
4622@end quotation
4623You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4624This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4625set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4626stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4627values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4628also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4629after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4630variable definitions may be gone.
4631
4632This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4633To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4634when compiling.
4635
d4f3574e
SS
4636@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4637Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4638unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4639opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4640offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4641might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4642happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4643
4644@example
4645No symbol "foo" in current context.
4646@end example
4647
4648To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4649different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4650formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4651supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4652in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4653to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4654debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4655Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4656information.
4657
4658
6d2ebf8b 4659@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4660@section Artificial arrays
4661
4662@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4663@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4664It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4665same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4666dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4667program.
4668
4669You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4670@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4671operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4672and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4673of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4674the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4675argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4676following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4677example. If a program says
4678
4679@example
4680int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4681@end example
4682
4683@noindent
4684you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4685
4686@example
4687p *array@@len
4688@end example
4689
4690The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4691with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4692subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4693Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4694(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4695
4696Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4697This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4698The value need not be in memory:
4699@example
4700(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4701$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4702@end example
4703
4704As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4705@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4706the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4707@example
4708(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4709$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4710@end example
4711
4712Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4713moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4714actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4715of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4716to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4717variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4718interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4719instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4720structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4721in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4722
4723@example
4724set $i = 0
4725p dtab[$i++]->fv
4726@key{RET}
4727@key{RET}
4728@dots{}
4729@end example
4730
6d2ebf8b 4731@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4732@section Output formats
4733
4734@cindex formatted output
4735@cindex output formats
4736By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4737this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4738in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4739at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4740these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4741
4742The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4743already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4744@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4745letters supported are:
4746
4747@table @code
4748@item x
4749Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4750hexadecimal.
4751
4752@item d
4753Print as integer in signed decimal.
4754
4755@item u
4756Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4757
4758@item o
4759Print as integer in octal.
4760
4761@item t
4762Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4763@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4764used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4765see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4766
4767@item a
4768@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4769@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4770Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4771the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4772where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4773
4774@example
4775(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4776$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4777@end example
4778
3d67e040
EZ
4779@noindent
4780The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4781@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4782
c906108c
SS
4783@item c
4784Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4785
4786@item f
4787Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4788using typical floating point syntax.
4789@end table
4790
4791For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4792
4793@example
4794p/x $pc
4795@end example
4796
4797@noindent
4798Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4799names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4800
4801To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4802you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4803expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4804
6d2ebf8b 4805@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4806@section Examining memory
4807
4808You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4809any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4810
4811@cindex examining memory
4812@table @code
41afff9a 4813@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4814@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4815@itemx x @var{addr}
4816@itemx x
4817Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4818@end table
4819
4820@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4821much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4822expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4823If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4824Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4825
4826@table @r
4827@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4828The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4829how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4830@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4831@c 4.1.2.
4832
4833@item @var{f}, the display format
4834The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4835@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4836The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4837The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4838
4839@item @var{u}, the unit size
4840The unit size is any of
4841
4842@table @code
4843@item b
4844Bytes.
4845@item h
4846Halfwords (two bytes).
4847@item w
4848Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4849@item g
4850Giant words (eight bytes).
4851@end table
4852
4853Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4854default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4855@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4856
4857@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4858@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4859memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4860it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4861@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4862@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4863other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4864the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4865starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4866a value from memory).
4867@end table
4868
4869For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4870(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4871starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4872words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4873@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4874
4875Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4876letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4877unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4878specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4879(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4880
4881Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4882and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4883@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4884including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4885alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4886Code,,Source and machine code}.
4887
4888All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4889easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4890you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4891instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4892with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4893the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4894for successive uses of @code{x}.
4895
4896@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4897The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4898in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4899would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4900subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4901@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4902examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4903@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4904the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4905
4906If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4907are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4908address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4909
6d2ebf8b 4910@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4911@section Automatic display
4912@cindex automatic display
4913@cindex display of expressions
4914
4915If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4916(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4917display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4918Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4919to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4920The automatic display looks like this:
4921
4922@example
49232: foo = 38
49243: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4925@end example
4926
4927@noindent
4928This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4929displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4930specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4931whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4932format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4933or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4934supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4935
4936@table @code
4937@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4938@item display @var{expr}
4939Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4940each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4941
4942@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4943
d4f3574e 4944@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4945For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4946count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4947arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4948@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4949
4950@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4951For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4952number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4953be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4954doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4955@end table
4956
4957For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4958instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4959is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4960
4961@table @code
4962@kindex delete display
4963@kindex undisplay
4964@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4965@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4966Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4967
4968@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4969(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4970
4971@kindex disable display
4972@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4973Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4974item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4975enabled again later.
4976
4977@kindex enable display
4978@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4979Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4980again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4981
4982@item display
4983Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4984done when your program stops.
4985
4986@kindex info display
4987@item info display
4988Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4989automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4990values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4991It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4992because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4993@end table
4994
4995If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4996sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4997expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4998variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4999@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5000@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5001continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5002there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5003automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5004is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5005
6d2ebf8b 5006@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5007@section Print settings
5008
5009@cindex format options
5010@cindex print settings
5011@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5012and symbols are printed.
5013
5014@noindent
5015These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5016
5017@table @code
5018@kindex set print address
5019@item set print address
5020@itemx set print address on
5021@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5022traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5023even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5024is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5025@code{set print address on}:
5026
5027@smallexample
5028@group
5029(@value{GDBP}) f
5030#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5031 at input.c:530
5032530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5033@end group
5034@end smallexample
5035
5036@item set print address off
5037Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5038this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5039
5040@smallexample
5041@group
5042(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5043(@value{GDBP}) f
5044#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5045530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5046@end group
5047@end smallexample
5048
5049You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5050dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5051@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5052all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5053
5054@kindex show print address
5055@item show print address
5056Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5057@end table
5058
5059When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5060closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5061identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5062source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5063@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5064you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5065it prints a symbolic address:
5066
5067@table @code
5068@kindex set print symbol-filename
5069@item set print symbol-filename on
5070Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5071symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5072
5073@item set print symbol-filename off
5074Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5075default.
5076
5077@kindex show print symbol-filename
5078@item show print symbol-filename
5079Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5080line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5081@end table
5082
5083Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5084numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5085number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5086
5087Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5088printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5089
5090@table @code
5091@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5092@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5093Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5094offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5095@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5096to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5097
5098@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5099@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5100Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5101symbolic address.
5102@end table
5103
5104@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5105@cindex pointer, finding referent
5106If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5107@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5108and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5109@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5110For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5111at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5112
5113@example
5114(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5115(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5116$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5117@end example
5118
5119@quotation
5120@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5121does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5122the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5123@end quotation
5124
5125Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5126
5127@table @code
5128@kindex set print array
5129@item set print array
5130@itemx set print array on
5131Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5132but uses more space. The default is off.
5133
5134@item set print array off
5135Return to compressed format for arrays.
5136
5137@kindex show print array
5138@item show print array
5139Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5140arrays.
5141
5142@kindex set print elements
5143@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5144Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5145If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5146printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5147This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5148When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5149Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5150
5151@kindex show print elements
5152@item show print elements
5153Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5154If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5155
5156@kindex set print null-stop
5157@item set print null-stop
5158Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5159@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5160contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5161The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5162
5163@kindex set print pretty
5164@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5165Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5166per line, like this:
5167
5168@smallexample
5169@group
5170$1 = @{
5171 next = 0x0,
5172 flags = @{
5173 sweet = 1,
5174 sour = 1
5175 @},
5176 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5177@}
5178@end group
5179@end smallexample
5180
5181@item set print pretty off
5182Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5183
5184@smallexample
5185@group
5186$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5187meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5188@end group
5189@end smallexample
5190
5191@noindent
5192This is the default format.
5193
5194@kindex show print pretty
5195@item show print pretty
5196Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5197
5198@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5199@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5200Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5201@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5202character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5203best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5204high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5205
5206@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5207Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5208international character sets, and is the default.
5209
5210@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5211@item show print sevenbit-strings
5212Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5213
5214@kindex set print union
5215@item set print union on
5d161b24 5216Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5217is the default setting.
5218
5219@item set print union off
5220Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5221
5222@kindex show print union
5223@item show print union
5224Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5225structures.
5226
5227For example, given the declarations
5228
5229@smallexample
5230typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5231typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5232typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5233 Bug_forms;
5234
5235struct thing @{
5236 Species it;
5237 union @{
5238 Tree_forms tree;
5239 Bug_forms bug;
5240 @} form;
5241@};
5242
5243struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5244@end smallexample
5245
5246@noindent
5247with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5248
5249@smallexample
5250$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5251@end smallexample
5252
5253@noindent
5254and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5255
5256@smallexample
5257$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5258@end smallexample
5259@end table
5260
c906108c
SS
5261@need 1000
5262@noindent
b37052ae 5263These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5264
5265@table @code
5266@cindex demangling
5267@kindex set print demangle
5268@item set print demangle
5269@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5270Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5271(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5272linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5273
5274@kindex show print demangle
5275@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5276Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5277
5278@kindex set print asm-demangle
5279@item set print asm-demangle
5280@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5281Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5282in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5283The default is off.
5284
5285@kindex show print asm-demangle
5286@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5287Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5288or demangled form.
5289
5290@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5291@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5292@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5293@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5294Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5295represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5296
5297@table @code
5298@item auto
5299Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5300
5301@item gnu
b37052ae 5302Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5303This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5304
5305@item hp
b37052ae 5306Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5307
5308@item lucid
b37052ae 5309Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5310
5311@item arm
b37052ae 5312Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5313@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5314debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5315require further enhancement to permit that.
5316
5317@end table
5318If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5319
5320@kindex show demangle-style
5321@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5322Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5323
5324@kindex set print object
5325@item set print object
5326@itemx set print object on
5327When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5328(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5329the virtual function table.
5330
5331@item set print object off
5332Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5333virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5334
5335@kindex show print object
5336@item show print object
5337Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5338
5339@kindex set print static-members
5340@item set print static-members
5341@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5342Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5343
5344@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5345Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5346
5347@kindex show print static-members
5348@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5349Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5350
5351@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5352@kindex set print vtbl
5353@item set print vtbl
5354@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5355Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5356(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5357ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5358
5359@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5360Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5361
5362@kindex show print vtbl
5363@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5364Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5365@end table
c906108c 5366
6d2ebf8b 5367@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5368@section Value history
5369
5370@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5371Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5372@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5373Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5374(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5375When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5376since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5377symbol table.
5378
5379@cindex @code{$}
5380@cindex @code{$$}
5381@cindex history number
5382The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5383refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5384@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5385printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5386history number.
5387
5388To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5389history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5390remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5391the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5392@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5393is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5394@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5395
5396For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5397want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5398
5399@example
5400p *$
5401@end example
5402
5403If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5404to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5405
5406@example
5407p *$.next
5408@end example
5409
5410@noindent
5411You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5412command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5413
5414Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5415@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5416
5417@example
5418print x
5419set x=5
5420@end example
5421
5422@noindent
5423then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5424remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5425
5426@table @code
5427@kindex show values
5428@item show values
5429Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5430This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5431values} does not change the history.
5432
5433@item show values @var{n}
5434Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5435
5436@item show values +
5437Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5438values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5439@end table
5440
5441Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5442same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5443
6d2ebf8b 5444@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5445@section Convenience variables
5446
5447@cindex convenience variables
5448@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5449@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5450exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5451setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5452of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5453
5454Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5455@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5456the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5457(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5458by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5459
5460You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5461expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5462For example:
5463
5464@example
5465set $foo = *object_ptr
5466@end example
5467
5468@noindent
5469would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5470@code{object_ptr}.
5471
5472Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5473value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5474value with another assignment at any time.
5475
5476Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5477variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5478that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5479variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5480
5481@table @code
5482@kindex show convenience
5483@item show convenience
5484Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5485Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5486@end table
5487
5488One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5489incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5490a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5491
5492@example
5493set $i = 0
5494print bar[$i++]->contents
5495@end example
5496
d4f3574e
SS
5497@noindent
5498Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5499
5500Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5501values likely to be useful.
5502
5503@table @code
41afff9a 5504@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5505@item $_
5506The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5507the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5508commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5509set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5510and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5511except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5512to the type of @code{$__}.
5513
41afff9a 5514@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5515@item $__
5516The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5517to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5518to match the format in which the data was printed.
5519
5520@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5521@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5522The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5523the program being debugged terminates.
5524@end table
5525
53a5351d
JM
5526On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5527begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5528name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5529
6d2ebf8b 5530@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5531@section Registers
5532
5533@cindex registers
5534You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5535with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5536for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5537your machine.
5538
5539@table @code
5540@kindex info registers
5541@item info registers
5542Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5543registers (in the selected stack frame).
5544
5545@kindex info all-registers
5546@cindex floating point registers
5547@item info all-registers
5548Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5549registers.
5550
5551@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5552Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5553As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5554the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5555the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5556@end table
5557
5558@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5559expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5560architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5561@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5562the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5563pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5564register that contains the processor status. For example,
5565you could print the program counter in hex with
5566
5567@example
5568p/x $pc
5569@end example
5570
5571@noindent
5572or print the instruction to be executed next with
5573
5574@example
5575x/i $pc
5576@end example
5577
5578@noindent
5579or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5580one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5581memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5582stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5583stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5584regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5585see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5586
5587@example
5588set $sp += 4
5589@end example
5590
5591Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5592your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5593so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5594shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5595registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5596can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5597is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5598
5599@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5600integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5601special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5602registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5603to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5604(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5605@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5606
5607Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5608means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5609the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5610sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5611coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5612programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5613cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5614that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5615prints the data in both formats.
5616
5617Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5618(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5619value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5620were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5621true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5622frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5623
5624However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5625code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5626@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5627frame makes no difference.
5628
6d2ebf8b 5629@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5630@section Floating point hardware
5631@cindex floating point
5632
5633Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5634you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5635
5636@table @code
5637@kindex info float
5638@item info float
5639Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5640point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5641floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5642the ARM and x86 machines.
5643@end table
c906108c 5644
29e57380
C
5645@node Memory Region Attributes
5646@section Memory Region Attributes
5647@cindex memory region attributes
5648
5649@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5650required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5651to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5652use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5653
5654Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5655memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5656accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5657been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5658all memory.
5659
5660When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5661to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5662
5663@table @code
5664@kindex mem
5665@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5666Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5667with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5668
5669@kindex delete mem
5670@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5671Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5672
5673@kindex disable mem
5674@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5675Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5676A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5677It may be enabled again later.
5678
5679@kindex enable mem
5680@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5681Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5682
5683@kindex info mem
5684@item info mem
5685Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5686for each region.
5687
5688@table @emph
5689@item Memory Region Number
5690@item Enabled or Disabled.
5691Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5692Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5693
5694@item Lo Address
5695The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5696
5697@item Hi Address
5698The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5699
5700@item Attributes
5701The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5702@end table
5703@end table
5704
5705
5706@subsection Attributes
5707
5708@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5709The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5710write accesses to a memory region.
5711
5712While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5713memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5714etc. from accessing memory.
5715
5716@table @code
5717@item ro
5718Memory is read only.
5719@item wo
5720Memory is write only.
5721@item rw
5722Memory is read/write (default).
5723@end table
5724
5725@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5726The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5727accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5728require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5729specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5730
5731@table @code
5732@item 8
5733Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5734@item 16
5735Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5736@item 32
5737Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5738@item 64
5739Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5740@end table
5741
5742@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5743@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5744@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5745@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5746@c
5747@c @table @code
5748@c @item hwbreak
5749@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5750@c @item swbreak (default)
5751@c @end table
5752
5753@subsubsection Data Cache
5754The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5755memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5756protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5757does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5758registers.
5759
5760@table @code
5761@item cache
5762Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5763@item nocache (default)
5764Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5765@end table
5766
5767@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5768@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5769@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5770@c
5771@c @table @code
5772@c @item verify
5773@c @item noverify (default)
5774@c @end table
5775
b37052ae
EZ
5776@node Tracepoints
5777@chapter Tracepoints
5778@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5779@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5780
5781@cindex tracepoints
5782In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5783the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5784anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5785depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5786might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5787fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5788to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5789
5790Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5791specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5792arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5793Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5794those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5795expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5796for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5797a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5798in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5799values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5800unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5801
5802The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5803targets. @xref{Targets}.
5804
5805This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5806
5807@menu
5808* Set Tracepoints::
5809* Analyze Collected Data::
5810* Tracepoint Variables::
5811@end menu
5812
5813@node Set Tracepoints
5814@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5815
5816Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5817tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5818tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5819breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5820one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5821tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5822work on.
5823
5824For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5825of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5826it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5827local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5828commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5829tracepoint was hit.
5830
5831This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5832conditions and actions.
5833
5834@menu
5835* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5836* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5837* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5838* Tracepoint Actions::
5839* Listing Tracepoints::
5840* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5841@end menu
5842
5843@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5844@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5845
5846@table @code
5847@cindex set tracepoint
5848@kindex trace
5849@item trace
5850The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5851Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5852the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5853defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5854debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5855program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5856doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5857cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5858running.
5859
5860Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5861
5862@smallexample
5863(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5864
5865(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5866
5867(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5868
5869(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5870
5871(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5872@end smallexample
5873
5874@noindent
5875You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5876
5877@vindex $tpnum
5878@cindex last tracepoint number
5879@cindex recent tracepoint number
5880@cindex tracepoint number
5881The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5882of the most recently set tracepoint.
5883
5884@kindex delete tracepoint
5885@cindex tracepoint deletion
5886@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5887Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5888default is to delete all tracepoints.
5889
5890Examples:
5891
5892@smallexample
5893(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5894
5895(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5896@end smallexample
5897
5898@noindent
5899You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5900@end table
5901
5902@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5903@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5904
5905@table @code
5906@kindex disable tracepoint
5907@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5908Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5909@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5910the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5911a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5912
5913@kindex enable tracepoint
5914@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5915Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5916tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5917run.
5918@end table
5919
5920@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5921@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5922
5923@table @code
5924@kindex passcount
5925@cindex tracepoint pass count
5926@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5927Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5928automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5929@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5930the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5931@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5932passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5933given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5934user.
5935
5936Examples:
5937
5938@smallexample
5939(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5940
5941(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5942 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5943(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5944(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5945(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5946(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5947(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5948(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5949 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5950 // been executed 2 times
5951 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5952@end smallexample
5953@end table
5954
5955@node Tracepoint Actions
5956@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5957
5958@table @code
5959@kindex actions
5960@cindex tracepoint actions
5961@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5962This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5963tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5964specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5965recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5966@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5967actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5968terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5969far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5970@code{while-stepping}.
5971
5972@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5973To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5974and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5975
5976@smallexample
5977(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5978
5979(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5980
5981(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5982@end smallexample
5983
5984In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5985commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5986hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5987following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5988followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5989@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5990@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5991@code{end} command.
5992
5993@smallexample
5994(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5995(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5996Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5997> collect bar,baz
5998> collect $regs
5999> while-stepping 12
6000 > collect $fp, $sp
6001 > end
6002end
6003@end smallexample
6004
6005@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6006@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6007Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6008This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6009In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6010special arguments are supported:
6011
6012@table @code
6013@item $regs
6014collect all registers
6015
6016@item $args
6017collect all function arguments
6018
6019@item $locals
6020collect all local variables.
6021@end table
6022
6023You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6024with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6025arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6026
f5c37c66
EZ
6027The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6028particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6029
b37052ae
EZ
6030@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6031@item while-stepping @var{n}
6032Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6033new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6034followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6035its own @code{end} command):
6036
6037@smallexample
6038> while-stepping 12
6039 > collect $regs, myglobal
6040 > end
6041>
6042@end smallexample
6043
6044@noindent
6045You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6046@code{stepping}.
6047@end table
6048
6049@node Listing Tracepoints
6050@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6051
6052@table @code
6053@kindex info tracepoints
6054@cindex information about tracepoints
6055@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6056Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
6057tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
6058defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6059shown:
6060
6061@itemize @bullet
6062@item
6063its number
6064@item
6065whether it is enabled or disabled
6066@item
6067its address
6068@item
6069its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6070@item
6071its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6072@item
6073where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6074@item
6075its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6076@end itemize
6077
6078@smallexample
6079(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6080Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
60811 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
60822 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
60833 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
6084(@value{GDBP})
6085@end smallexample
6086
6087@noindent
6088This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6089@end table
6090
6091@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6092@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6093
6094@table @code
6095@kindex tstart
6096@cindex start a new trace experiment
6097@cindex collected data discarded
6098@item tstart
6099This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6100begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6101the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6102experiment.
6103
6104@kindex tstop
6105@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6106@item tstop
6107This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6108stops collecting data.
6109
6110@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6111automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6112(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6113
6114@kindex tstatus
6115@cindex status of trace data collection
6116@cindex trace experiment, status of
6117@item tstatus
6118This command displays the status of the current trace data
6119collection.
6120@end table
6121
6122Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6123
6124@smallexample
6125(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6126(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6127Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6128> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6129> while-stepping 11
6130 > collect $regs
6131 > end
6132> end
6133(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6134 [time passes @dots{}]
6135(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6136@end smallexample
6137
6138
6139@node Analyze Collected Data
6140@section Using the collected data
6141
6142After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6143for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6144collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6145snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6146consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6147examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6148specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6149snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6150registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6151rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6152debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6153(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6154behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6155when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6156the buffer will fail.
6157
6158@menu
6159* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6160* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6161* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6162@end menu
6163
6164@node tfind
6165@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6166
6167@kindex tfind
6168@cindex select trace snapshot
6169@cindex find trace snapshot
6170The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6171@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6172counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6173snapshot is selected.
6174
6175Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6176
6177@table @code
6178@item tfind start
6179Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6180@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6181
6182@item tfind none
6183Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6184
6185@item tfind end
6186Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6187
6188@item tfind
6189No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6190
6191@item tfind -
6192Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6193retracing earlier steps.
6194
6195@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6196Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6197proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6198argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6199for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6200
6201@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6202Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6203program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6204snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6205snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6206
6207@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6208Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6209addresses.
6210
6211@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6212Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6213@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6214
6215@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6216Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6217the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6218that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6219trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6220next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6221@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6222stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6223@end table
6224
6225The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6226designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6227instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6228snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6229trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6230simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6231snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6232@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6233The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6234for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6235no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6236(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6237no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6238tracepoint as the current one.
6239
6240In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6241these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6242scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6243you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6244registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6245
6246@smallexample
6247(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6248(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6249> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6250 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6251> tfind
6252> end
6253
6254Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6255Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6256Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6257Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6258Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6259Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6260Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6261Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6262Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6263Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6264Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6265@end smallexample
6266
6267Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6268the buffer:
6269
6270@smallexample
6271(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6272(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6273> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6274> tfind line
6275> end
6276
6277Frame 0, X = 1
6278Frame 7, X = 2
6279Frame 13, X = 255
6280@end smallexample
6281
6282@node tdump
6283@subsection @code{tdump}
6284@kindex tdump
6285@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6286@cindex tracepoint data, display
6287
6288This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6289the current trace snapshot.
6290
6291@smallexample
6292(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6293(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6294Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6295> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6296> end
6297
6298(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6299
6300(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6301#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6302at gdb_test.c:444
6303444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6304
6305(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6306Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6307d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6308d1 0x18 24
6309d2 0x80 128
6310d3 0x33 51
6311d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6312d5 0x22 34
6313d6 0xe0 224
6314d7 0x380035 3670069
6315a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6316a1 0x3000668 50333288
6317a2 0x100 256
6318a3 0x322000 3284992
6319a4 0x3000698 50333336
6320a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6321fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6322sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6323ps 0x0 0
6324pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6325fpcontrol 0x0 0
6326fpstatus 0x0 0
6327fpiaddr 0x0 0
6328p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6329p1 = (void *) 0x11
6330p2 = (void *) 0x22
6331p3 = (void *) 0x33
6332p4 = (void *) 0x44
6333p5 = (void *) 0x55
6334p6 = (void *) 0x66
6335gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6336
6337(@value{GDBP})
6338@end smallexample
6339
6340@node save-tracepoints
6341@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6342@kindex save-tracepoints
6343@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6344
6345This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6346their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6347suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6348tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6349Files}).
6350
6351@node Tracepoint Variables
6352@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6353@cindex tracepoint variables
6354@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6355
6356@table @code
6357@vindex $trace_frame
6358@item (int) $trace_frame
6359The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6360snapshot is selected.
6361
6362@vindex $tracepoint
6363@item (int) $tracepoint
6364The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6365
6366@vindex $trace_line
6367@item (int) $trace_line
6368The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6369
6370@vindex $trace_file
6371@item (char []) $trace_file
6372The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6373
6374@vindex $trace_func
6375@item (char []) $trace_func
6376The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6377@end table
6378
6379Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6380use @code{output} instead.
6381
6382Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6383stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6384data.
6385
6386@smallexample
6387(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6388
6389(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6390> output $trace_file
6391> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6392> tfind
6393> end
6394@end smallexample
6395
df0cd8c5
JB
6396@node Overlays
6397@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6398@cindex overlays
6399
6400If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6401memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6402problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6403use overlays.
6404
6405@menu
6406* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6407* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6408* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6409 mapped by asking the inferior.
6410* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6411@end menu
6412
6413@node How Overlays Work
6414@section How Overlays Work
6415@cindex mapped overlays
6416@cindex unmapped overlays
6417@cindex load address, overlay's
6418@cindex mapped address
6419@cindex overlay area
6420
6421Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
6422kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
6423other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
6424management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
6425adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
6426
6427One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
6428independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
6429@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
6430their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
6431instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
6432largest overlay as well.
6433
6434Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
6435overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
6436for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
6437there.
6438
6439@example
6440@group
6441 Data Instruction Larger
6442Address Space Address Space Address Space
6443+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
6444| | | | | |
6445+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
6446| program | | main | | | load address
6447| variables | | program | | overlay 1 |
6448| and heap | | | ,---| |
6449+-----------+ | | | | |
6450| | +-----------+ | +-----------+
6451+-----------+ | | | | |
6452 mapped --->+-----------+ / +-----------+<-- overlay 2
6453 address | overlay | <-' | overlay 2 | load address
6454 | area | <-----| |
6455 | | <---. +-----------+
6456 | | | | |
6457 +-----------+ | | |
6458 | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 3
6459 +-----------+ `--| | load address
6460 | overlay 3 |
6461 | |
6462 +-----------+
6463 | |
6464 +-----------+
6465
6466 To map an overlay, copy its code from the larger address space
6467 to the instruction address space. Since the overlays shown here
6468 all use the same mapped address, only one may be mapped at a time.
6469@end group
6470@end example
6471
6472This diagram shows a system with separate data and instruction address
6473spaces. For a system with a single address space for data and
6474instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the program
6475variables and heap would share an address space with the main program
6476and the overlay area.
6477
6478An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
6479@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
6480instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
6481in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
6482is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
6483the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
6484called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
6485
6486Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
6487program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
6488global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
6489
6490@itemize @bullet
6491
6492@item
6493Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
6494must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
6495return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
6496overlay, and your program will probably crash.
6497
6498@item
6499If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
6500will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
6501your program's performance.
6502
6503@item
6504The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
6505overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
6506mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
6507and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
6508You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
6509addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
6510ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
6511
6512@item
6513The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
6514to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
6515instruction and data spaces.
6516
6517@end itemize
6518
6519The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
6520improved in many ways:
6521
6522@itemize @bullet
6523
6524@item
6525If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
6526hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
6527contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
6528This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
6529area in the usual way.
6530
6531@item
6532If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
6533overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
6534
6535@item
6536You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
6537general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
6538code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
6539return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
6540the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
6541must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
6542different data overlay into the same mapped area.
6543
6544@end itemize
6545
6546
6547@node Overlay Commands
6548@section Overlay Commands
6549
6550To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
6551correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
6552virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
6553mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
6554@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
6555variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
6556
6557@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
6558you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
6559
6560@table @code
6561@item overlay off
6562@kindex overlay off
6563Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
6564disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
6565always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
6566overlay support is disabled.
6567
6568@item overlay manual
6569@kindex overlay manual
6570@cindex manual overlay debugging
6571Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6572relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
6573using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
6574commands described below.
6575
6576@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
6577@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
6578@kindex overlay map-overlay
6579@cindex map an overlay
6580Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
6581be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
6582overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
6583functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
6584that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
6585@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
6586
6587@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
6588@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
6589@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
6590@cindex unmap an overlay
6591Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
6592must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
6593When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
6594overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
6595
6596@item overlay auto
6597@kindex overlay auto
6598Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6599consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
6600to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
6601Overlay Debugging}.
6602
6603@item overlay load-target
6604@itemx overlay load
6605@kindex overlay load-target
6606@cindex reloading the overlay table
6607Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
6608re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
6609stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
6610overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
6611useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
6612
6613@item overlay list-overlays
6614@itemx overlay list
6615@cindex listing mapped overlays
6616Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
6617addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
6618
6619@end table
6620
6621Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
6622of the function the address falls in:
6623
6624@example
6625(gdb) print main
6626$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
6627@end example
6628@noindent
6629When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
6630unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
6631asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
6632unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
6633
6634@example
6635(gdb) overlay list
6636No sections are mapped.
6637(gdb) print foo
6638$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
6639@end example
6640@noindent
6641When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
6642name normally:
6643
6644@example
6645(gdb) overlay list
6646Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
6647 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
6648(gdb) print foo
6649$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
6650@end example
6651
6652When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
6653address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
6654overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
6655@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
6656code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
6657
6658@itemize @bullet
6659@item
6660@cindex breakpoints in overlays
6661@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
6662You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
6663@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
6664@item
6665@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
6666unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
6667overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
6668you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
6669breakpoints properly.
6670@end itemize
6671
6672
6673@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
6674@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
6675@cindex automatic overlay debugging
6676
6677@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
6678are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
6679inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
6680@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
6681looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
6682current state of the overlays.
6683
6684Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
6685@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
6686
6687@table @asis
6688
6689@item @code{_ovly_table}:
6690This variable must be an array of the following structures:
6691
6692@example
6693struct
6694@{
6695 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
6696 unsigned long vma;
6697
6698 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
6699 unsigned long size;
6700
6701 /* The overlay's load address. */
6702 unsigned long lma;
6703
6704 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
6705 zero otherwise. */
6706 unsigned long mapped;
6707@}
6708@end example
6709
6710@item @code{_novlys}:
6711This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
6712number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
6713
6714@end table
6715
6716To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
6717looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
6718@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
6719executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
6720the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
6721currently mapped.
6722
6723
6724@node Overlay Sample Program
6725@section Overlay Sample Program
6726@cindex overlay example program
6727
6728When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
6729at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
6730addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
6731Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
6732since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
6733architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
6734portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
6735
6736However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
6737program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
6738suite. The program consists of the following files from
6739@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
6740
6741@table @file
6742@item overlays.c
6743The main program file.
6744@item ovlymgr.c
6745A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
6746@item foo.c
6747@itemx bar.c
6748@itemx baz.c
6749@itemx grbx.c
6750Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
6751@item d10v.ld
6752@itemx m32r.ld
6753Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
6754and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
6755@end table
6756
6757You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
6758cross-compiler like this:
6759
6760@example
6761$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
6762$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
6763$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
6764$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
6765$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
6766$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
6767$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
6768 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
6769@end example
6770
6771The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
6772you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
6773target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
6774
6775
6d2ebf8b 6776@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6777@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6778@cindex languages
6779
c906108c
SS
6780Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6781rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6782dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6783Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6784represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6785@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6786
6787@cindex working language
6788Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6789allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6790native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6791consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6792language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6793language}.
6794
6795@menu
6796* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6797* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6798* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6799* Support:: Supported languages
6800@end menu
6801
6d2ebf8b 6802@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6803@section Switching between source languages
6804
6805There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6806set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6807@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6808defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6809used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6810are printed, etc.
6811
6812In addition to the working language, every source file that
6813@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6814file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6815source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6816language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6817controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6818show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6819set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6820set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6821Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6822
6823This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6824as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6825another language. In that case, make the
6826program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6827@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6828program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6829
6830@menu
6831* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6832* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6833* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6834@end menu
6835
6d2ebf8b 6836@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6837@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6838
6839If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6840@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6841
6842@table @file
6843
6844@item .c
6845C source file
6846
6847@item .C
6848@itemx .cc
6849@itemx .cp
6850@itemx .cpp
6851@itemx .cxx
6852@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6853C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6854
6855@item .f
6856@itemx .F
6857Fortran source file
6858
c906108c
SS
6859@item .ch
6860@itemx .c186
6861@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6862CHILL source file
c906108c 6863
c906108c
SS
6864@item .mod
6865Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6866
6867@item .s
6868@itemx .S
6869Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6870@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6871@end table
6872
6873In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6874extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6875
6d2ebf8b 6876@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6877@subsection Setting the working language
6878
6879If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6880expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6881your program.
6882
6883@kindex set language
6884If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6885command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6886a language, such as
c906108c 6887@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6888For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6889
c906108c
SS
6890Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6891language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6892to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6893source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6894languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6895source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6896command such as:
6897
6898@example
6899print a = b + c
6900@end example
6901
6902@noindent
6903might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6904@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6905printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6906@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6907
6d2ebf8b 6908@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6909@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6910
6911To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6912@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6913then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6914frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6915working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6916frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6917or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6918does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6919not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6920
6921This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6922entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6923written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6924a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6925case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6926
6d2ebf8b 6927@node Show
c906108c 6928@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6929
6930The following commands help you find out which language is the
6931working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6932
6933@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6934@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6935@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6936@table @code
6937@item show language
6938Display the current working language. This is the
6939language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6940build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6941
6942@item info frame
5d161b24 6943Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6944working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6945@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6946information listed here.
6947
6948@item info source
6949Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6950@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6951information listed here.
6952@end table
6953
6954In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6955not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6956with a language explicitly:
6957
6958@kindex set extension-language
6959@kindex info extensions
6960@table @code
6961@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6962Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6963the source language @var{language}.
6964
6965@item info extensions
6966List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6967@end table
6968
6d2ebf8b 6969@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6970@section Type and range checking
6971
6972@quotation
6973@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6974checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6975section documents the intended facilities.
6976@end quotation
6977@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6978
6979Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6980errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6981checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6982sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6983these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6984by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6985errors when your program is running.
6986
6987@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6988Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6989can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6990the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6991@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6992your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6993for the default settings of supported languages.
6994
6995@menu
6996* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6997* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6998@end menu
6999
7000@cindex type checking
7001@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7002@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7003@subsection An overview of type checking
7004
7005Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7006arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7007otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7008errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7009
7010@smallexample
70111 + 2 @result{} 3
7012@exdent but
7013@error{} 1 + 2.3
7014@end smallexample
7015
7016The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7017type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7018
5d161b24
DB
7019For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7020@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7021to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7022or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7023but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7024these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7025also issues a warning.
7026
5d161b24
DB
7027Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7028related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7029For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7030a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7031with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7032the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7033
7034Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7035instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7036operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7037represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7038operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7039details on specific languages.
7040
7041@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7042
d4f3574e 7043@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7044@kindex set check type
7045@kindex show check type
7046@table @code
7047@item set check type auto
7048Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7049@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7050each language.
7051
7052@item set check type on
7053@itemx set check type off
7054Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7055current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7056match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7057evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7058message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7059
7060@item set check type warn
7061Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7062evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7063be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7064numbers and structures.
7065
7066@item show type
5d161b24 7067Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7068is setting it automatically.
7069@end table
7070
7071@cindex range checking
7072@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7073@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7074@subsection An overview of range checking
7075
7076In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7077bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7078checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7079computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7080not exceed the bounds of the array.
7081
7082For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7083@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7084always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7085warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7086
7087A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7088array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7089of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7090error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7091result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7092the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7093
7094@example
7095@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7096@end example
7097
7098This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7099specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7100Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7101
7102@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7103
d4f3574e 7104@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7105@kindex set check range
7106@kindex show check range
7107@table @code
7108@item set check range auto
7109Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7110@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7111each language.
7112
7113@item set check range on
7114@itemx set check range off
7115Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7116current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7117match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7118then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7119
7120@item set check range warn
7121Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7122but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7123expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7124memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7125systems).
7126
7127@item show range
7128Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7129being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7130@end table
c906108c 7131
6d2ebf8b 7132@node Support
c906108c 7133@section Supported languages
c906108c 7134
b37052ae 7135@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7136@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7137Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7138language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7139and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7140,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7141language.
7142
7143The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7144supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7145tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7146@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7147formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7148books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7149language reference or tutorial.
7150
c906108c 7151@menu
b37052ae 7152* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7153* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 7154* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
7155@end menu
7156
6d2ebf8b 7157@node C
b37052ae 7158@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7159
b37052ae
EZ
7160@cindex C and C@t{++}
7161@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7162
b37052ae 7163Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7164to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7165together.
7166
41afff9a
EZ
7167@cindex C@t{++}
7168@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7169@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7170The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7171compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7172effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7173C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7174compiler (@code{aCC}).
7175
b37052ae 7176For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7177format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7178command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7179@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7180CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7181
c906108c 7182@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7183* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7184* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7185* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7186* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7187* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7188* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7189* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7190@end menu
c906108c 7191
6d2ebf8b 7192@node C Operators
b37052ae 7193@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7194
b37052ae 7195@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7196
7197Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7198@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7199often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7200
b37052ae 7201For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7202
7203@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7204
c906108c 7205@item
c906108c 7206@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7207specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7208
7209@item
d4f3574e
SS
7210@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7211@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7212
7213@item
53a5351d 7214@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7215
7216@item
7217@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7218
c906108c
SS
7219@end itemize
7220
7221@noindent
7222The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7223in order of increasing precedence:
7224
7225@table @code
7226@item ,
7227The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7228are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7229expression being the last expression evaluated.
7230
7231@item =
7232Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7233assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7234
7235@item @var{op}=
7236Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7237and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7238@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7239@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7240@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7241
7242@item ?:
7243The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7244of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7245integral type.
7246
7247@item ||
7248Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7249
7250@item &&
7251Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7252
7253@item |
7254Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7255
7256@item ^
7257Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7258
7259@item &
7260Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7261
7262@item ==@r{, }!=
7263Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7264expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7265
7266@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7267Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7268Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7269and non-zero for true.
7270
7271@item <<@r{, }>>
7272left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7273
7274@item @@
7275The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7276
7277@item +@r{, }-
7278Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7279pointer types.
7280
7281@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7282Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7283defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7284integral types.
7285
7286@item ++@r{, }--
7287Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7288operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7289when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7290operation takes place.
7291
7292@item *
7293Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7294@code{++}.
7295
7296@item &
7297Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7298
b37052ae
EZ
7299For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7300allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7301(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7302where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7303stored.
c906108c
SS
7304
7305@item -
7306Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7307precedence as @code{++}.
7308
7309@item !
7310Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7311@code{++}.
7312
7313@item ~
7314Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7315@code{++}.
7316
7317
7318@item .@r{, }->
7319Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7320@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7321pointer based on the stored type information.
7322Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7323
c906108c
SS
7324@item .*@r{, }->*
7325Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7326
7327@item []
7328Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7329@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7330
7331@item ()
7332Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7333
c906108c 7334@item ::
b37052ae 7335C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7336and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7337
7338@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7339Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7340(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7341above.
c906108c
SS
7342@end table
7343
c906108c
SS
7344If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7345attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7346predefined meaning.
c906108c 7347
c906108c 7348@menu
5d161b24 7349* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7350@end menu
7351
6d2ebf8b 7352@node C Constants
b37052ae 7353@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7354
b37052ae 7355@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7356
b37052ae 7357@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7358following ways:
c906108c
SS
7359
7360@itemize @bullet
7361@item
7362Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
7363specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
7364a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
7365@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7366@code{long} value.
7367
7368@item
7369Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7370point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7371exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7372@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7373sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7374A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7375@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7376the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7377a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7378constant.
c906108c
SS
7379
7380@item
7381Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7382integral equivalents.
7383
7384@item
7385Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7386(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7387(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
7388be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7389the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7390of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7391@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7392@samp{\n} for newline.
7393
7394@item
96a2c332
SS
7395String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7396double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7397above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7398a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7399characters.
c906108c
SS
7400
7401@item
7402Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
7403to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
7404
7405@item
7406Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
7407and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
7408integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
7409and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
7410@end itemize
7411
c906108c 7412@menu
5d161b24
DB
7413* C plus plus expressions::
7414* C Defaults::
7415* C Checks::
c906108c 7416
5d161b24 7417* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
7418@end menu
7419
6d2ebf8b 7420@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
7421@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
7422
7423@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
7424@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
7425
7426@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
7427@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
7428@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
7429@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
7430@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
7431@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
7432@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
7433@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
7434@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7435@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
7436@c periodically whether this has happened...
7437@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
7438@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
7439proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
7440additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
7441special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
7442@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
7443symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
7444you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
7445extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 7446@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7447support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
7448@end quotation
c906108c
SS
7449
7450@enumerate
7451
7452@cindex member functions
7453@item
7454Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
7455
7456@example
7457count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
7458@end example
7459
41afff9a 7460@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 7461@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7462@item
7463While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
7464expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
7465that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 7466pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 7467
c906108c 7468@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 7469@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 7470@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7471@item
7472You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 7473call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
7474perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
7475calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
7476in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
7477default arguments.
7478
7479It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
7480promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
7481class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
7482functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
7483number of function arguments.
7484
7485Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
7486@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 7487,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 7488
d4f3574e 7489You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
7490explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
7491@smallexample
7492p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7493@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7494
c906108c 7495The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 7496see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 7497
c906108c
SS
7498@cindex reference declarations
7499@item
b37052ae
EZ
7500@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7501them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7502dereferenced.
7503
7504In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7505reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7506avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7507The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7508you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7509
7510@item
b37052ae 7511@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7512expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7513one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7514necessary, for example in an expression like
7515@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7516resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7517debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7518@end enumerate
7519
b37052ae 7520In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7521calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7522objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7523invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7524
6d2ebf8b 7525@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7526@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7527
b37052ae 7528@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7529
c906108c
SS
7530If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7531both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7532C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7533selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7534
7535If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7536recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7537@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7538these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7539@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7540for further details.
7541
c906108c
SS
7542@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7543@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7544@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7545
6d2ebf8b 7546@node C Checks
b37052ae 7547@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7548
b37052ae 7549@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7550
b37052ae 7551By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7552is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7553considers two variables type equivalent if:
7554
7555@itemize @bullet
7556@item
7557The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7558enumerated tag.
7559
7560@item
7561The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7562declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7563
7564@ignore
7565@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7566@c FIXME--beers?
7567@item
7568The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7569declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7570compilers.)
7571@end ignore
7572@end itemize
7573
7574Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7575indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7576that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7577
6d2ebf8b 7578@node Debugging C
c906108c 7579@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7580
7581The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7582the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7583inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7584appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7585
7586The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7587with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7588,Expressions}.
7589
c906108c 7590@menu
5d161b24 7591* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7592@end menu
7593
6d2ebf8b 7594@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7595@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7596
b37052ae 7597@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7598
b37052ae
EZ
7599Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7600designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7601
7602@table @code
7603@cindex break in overloaded functions
7604@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7605When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7606@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7607you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7608
b37052ae 7609@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7610@item rbreak @var{regex}
7611Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7612breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7613classes.
7614@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7615
b37052ae 7616@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7617@item catch throw
7618@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7619Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7620Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7621
7622@cindex inheritance
7623@item ptype @var{typename}
7624Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7625@var{typename}.
7626@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7627
b37052ae 7628@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7629@item set print demangle
7630@itemx show print demangle
7631@itemx set print asm-demangle
7632@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7633Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7634displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7635@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7636
7637@item set print object
7638@itemx show print object
7639Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7640@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7641
7642@item set print vtbl
7643@itemx show print vtbl
7644Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7645@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7646(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7647ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7648
7649@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7650@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7651@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7652Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7653is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7654and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7655using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7656expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7657message.
7658
7659@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7660Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7661overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7662chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7663symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7664overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7665searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7666argument types.
c906108c
SS
7667
7668@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7669You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7670the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7671@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7672also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7673available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7674@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7675@end table
c906108c 7676
6d2ebf8b 7677@node Modula-2
c906108c 7678@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7679
d4f3574e 7680@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7681
7682The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7683output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7684developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7685attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7686to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7687table.
7688
7689@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7690@menu
7691* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7692* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7693* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7694* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7695* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7696* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7697* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7698* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7699@end menu
7700
6d2ebf8b 7701@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7702@subsubsection Operators
7703@cindex Modula-2 operators
7704
7705Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7706@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7707often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7708following definitions hold:
7709
7710@itemize @bullet
7711
7712@item
7713@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7714their subranges.
7715
7716@item
7717@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7718
7719@item
7720@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7721
7722@item
7723@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7724@var{type}}.
7725
7726@item
7727@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7728
7729@item
7730@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7731
7732@item
7733@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7734@end itemize
7735
7736@noindent
7737The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7738increasing precedence:
7739
7740@table @code
7741@item ,
7742Function argument or array index separator.
7743
7744@item :=
7745Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7746@var{value}.
7747
7748@item <@r{, }>
7749Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7750types.
7751
7752@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7753Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7754on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7755set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7756
7757@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7758Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7759Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7760available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7761comment character.
7762
7763@item IN
7764Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7765Same precedence as @code{<}.
7766
7767@item OR
7768Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7769
7770@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7771Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7772
7773@item @@
7774The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7775
7776@item +@r{, }-
7777Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7778and difference on set types.
7779
7780@item *
7781Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7782on set types.
7783
7784@item /
7785Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7786types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7787
7788@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7789Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7790precedence as @code{*}.
7791
7792@item -
7793Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7794
7795@item ^
7796Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7797
7798@item NOT
7799Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7800@code{^}.
7801
7802@item .
7803@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7804precedence as @code{^}.
7805
7806@item []
7807Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7808
7809@item ()
7810Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7811as @code{^}.
7812
7813@item ::@r{, }.
7814@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7815@end table
7816
7817@quotation
7818@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7819treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7820@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7821@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7822@end quotation
7823
cb51c4e0 7824
6d2ebf8b 7825@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 7826@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 7827@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
7828
7829Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7830In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7831
7832@table @var
7833
7834@item a
7835represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7836
7837@item c
7838represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7839
7840@item i
7841represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7842
7843@item m
7844represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7845same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7846be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7847
7848@item n
7849represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7850
7851@item r
7852represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7853
7854@item t
7855represents a type.
7856
7857@item v
7858represents a variable.
7859
7860@item x
7861represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7862explanation of the function for details.
7863@end table
7864
7865All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7866
7867@table @code
7868@item ABS(@var{n})
7869Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7870
7871@item CAP(@var{c})
7872If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7873equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7874
7875@item CHR(@var{i})
7876Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7877
7878@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7879Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7880
7881@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7882Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7883new value.
7884
7885@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7886Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7887set.
7888
7889@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7890Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7891
7892@item HIGH(@var{a})
7893Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7894
7895@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7896Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7897
7898@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7899Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7900new value.
7901
7902@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7903Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7904there. Returns the new set.
7905
7906@item MAX(@var{t})
7907Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7908
7909@item MIN(@var{t})
7910Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7911
7912@item ODD(@var{i})
7913Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7914
7915@item ORD(@var{x})
7916Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7917value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7918@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7919integral, character and enumerated types.
7920
7921@item SIZE(@var{x})
7922Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7923
7924@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7925Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7926
7927@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7928Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7929@end table
7930
7931@quotation
7932@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7933@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7934an error.
7935@end quotation
7936
7937@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7938@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7939@subsubsection Constants
7940
7941@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7942ways:
7943
7944@itemize @bullet
7945
7946@item
7947Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7948expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7949rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7950trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7951
7952@item
7953Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7954decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7955then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7956@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7957digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7958digits.
7959
7960@item
7961Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7962like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7963also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7964followed by a @samp{C}.
7965
7966@item
7967String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7968pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7969Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7970Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7971sequences.
7972
7973@item
7974Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7975
7976@item
7977Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7978@code{FALSE}.
7979
7980@item
7981Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7982
7983@item
7984Set constants are not yet supported.
7985@end itemize
7986
6d2ebf8b 7987@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7988@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7989@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7990
7991If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7992both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7993Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7994selected the working language.
7995
7996If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7997code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7998working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7999the language automatically}, for further details.
8000
6d2ebf8b 8001@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8002@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8003@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8004
8005A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8006This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8007
8008@itemize @bullet
8009@item
8010Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8011integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8012debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8013pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8014through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8015returned a pointer.)
8016
8017@item
8018C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8019non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8020escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8021printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8022
8023@item
8024The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8025argument.
8026
8027@item
8028All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8029@end itemize
8030
6d2ebf8b 8031@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8032@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8033@cindex Modula-2 checks
8034
8035@quotation
8036@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8037range checking.
8038@end quotation
8039@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8040
8041@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8042
8043@itemize @bullet
8044@item
8045They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8046@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8047
8048@item
8049They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8050@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8051@end itemize
8052
8053As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8054whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8055
8056Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8057index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8058
6d2ebf8b 8059@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8060@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8061@cindex scope
41afff9a 8062@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8063@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8064@ifinfo
41afff9a 8065@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8066@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8067@end ifinfo
8068@iftex
41afff9a 8069@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8070@end iftex
8071
8072There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8073(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8074similar syntax:
8075
8076@example
8077
8078@var{module} . @var{id}
8079@var{scope} :: @var{id}
8080@end example
8081
8082@noindent
8083where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8084@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8085identifier within your program, except another module.
8086
8087Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8088specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8089found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8090enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8091
8092Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8093the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8094definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8095an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8096module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8097@var{module}.
8098
6d2ebf8b 8099@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8100@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8101
8102Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8103Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8104specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8105@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8106apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8107analogue in Modula-2.
8108
8109The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8110with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8111intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8112created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8113address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8114@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8115
8116@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8117In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8118interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8119
6d2ebf8b 8120@node Chill
cce74817
JM
8121@subsection Chill
8122
8123The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 8124from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
8125supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8126likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8127table.
8128
d4f3574e
SS
8129@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8130@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8131This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
8132of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8133
8134@menu
104c1213
JM
8135* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8136* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 8137* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 8138* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 8139* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
8140@end menu
8141
6d2ebf8b 8142@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
8143@subsubsection How modes are displayed
8144
8145The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 8146with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
8147slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8148provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
8149
8150@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8151@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
8152@table @code
8153@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8154@itemize @bullet
8155@item
8156@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8157UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8158@item
5d161b24 8159@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 8160@item
5d161b24 8161@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
8162@item
8163@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8164@smallexample
8165(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8166type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8167@end smallexample
8168If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8169@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8170@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8171@smallexample
8172@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8173@end smallexample
8174where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8175expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
8176@end itemize
8177
8178@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8179A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 8180the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
8181@smallexample
8182(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8183type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8184@end smallexample
8185
8186@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8187@itemize @bullet
8188@item
d4f3574e 8189@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
8190followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8191@item
8192@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8193@end itemize
8194
8195@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8196The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8197<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
8198list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8199the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
8200all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8201
8202@ignore
8203@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8204The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 8205type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
8206@end ignore
8207
5d161b24 8208@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
8209@itemize @bullet
8210@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8211@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8212@smallexample
8213@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8214@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
8215where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8216@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8217@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8218@smallexample
8219@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8220@end smallexample
8221where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
8222@end itemize
8223
5d161b24 8224@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
8225@itemize @bullet
8226@item
8227@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8228@item
8229@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8230@end itemize
8231
8232@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8233Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8234
8235@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8236@itemize @bullet
8237@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8238@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8239@smallexample
8240@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8241@end smallexample
8242followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8243mode
cce74817 8244@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8245@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8246@smallexample
8247@code{BOOLS(<string
8248length>)}
8249@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
8250@end itemize
8251
8252@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8253The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8254followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8255@smallexample
8256(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
8257type = ARRAY (1:42)
8258 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
8259 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8260@end smallexample
8261
5d161b24 8262@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 8263The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
8264list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8265of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8266OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
8267of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8268checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8269always displays all variant fields.
8270@smallexample
8271(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8272type = STRUCT (
8273 as x,
8274 bs x,
8275 CASE bs OF
8276 (karli):
8277 cs a
8278 (ott):
8279 ds x
8280 ESAC
8281)
8282@end smallexample
8283@end table
8284
6d2ebf8b 8285@node Locations
cce74817
JM
8286@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8287
8288A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8289
8290A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
8291the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8292Chill programs. How values are specified
8293is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
8294
8295The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8296display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 8297
cce74817
JM
8298@smallexample
8299set result := EXPR
8300@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
8301
8302@noindent
8303This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 8304is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
8305
8306Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8307value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 8308mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
8309represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8310value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 8311operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 8312
6d2ebf8b
SS
8313Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8314@smallexample
8315@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 8316(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
8317location>}
8318@end smallexample
8319@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8320specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8321the entry point.
cce74817
JM
8322
8323@ignore
8324Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8325fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8326the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
8327implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8328na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8329<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
8330@code{__proc_copy}.
8331
8332Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8333the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8334like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8335mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8336
8337Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 8338...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 8339definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
8340of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8341structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8342braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 8343on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 8344memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 8345all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 8346@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
8347stuff ???)
8348@smallexample
8349(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8350[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8351@end smallexample
8352@end ignore
8353
8354Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8355(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
8356certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8357and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
8358
8359A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
8360location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8361name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8362have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8363checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 8364therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 8365
cce74817
JM
8366@smallexample
8367(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8368@end smallexample
8369
6d2ebf8b 8370@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
8371@subsubsection Values and their Operations
8372
8373Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8374more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
8375data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8376such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 8377constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 8378when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
8379(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8380the values behind these locations.
8381
d4f3574e 8382This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
8383operations are legal to be used with such values.
8384
8385@table @code
8386@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
8387Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8388For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 8389chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
8390@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8391@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 8392
5d161b24 8393@ignore
cce74817
JM
8394@itemize @bullet
8395@item
8396@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 8397programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
8398@item
8399@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8400@item
8401@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
8402@code{'M'})
8403@item
8404@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 8405mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 8406comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 8407@item
d4f3574e 8408@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 8409emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 8410procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
8411
8412@item
8413@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 8414enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
8415to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
8416@item
8417@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8418programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
8419@item
8420@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 8421(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
8422@end itemize
8423@end ignore
8424
8425@item Tuple Values
8426A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 8427name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
8428unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
8429@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 8430
cce74817
JM
8431@itemize @bullet
8432@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
8433@item @emph{Array Tuple}
8434@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
8435Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 8436same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
8437@end itemize
8438
8439@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
8440A string element value is specified by
8441@smallexample
8442@code{<string value>(<index>)}
8443@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8444where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
8445value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
8446the string.
8447
8448@item String Slice Value
8449A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
8450spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
8451expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
8452@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
8453The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
8454string.
8455
8456@item Array Element Values
8457An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
8458delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
8459
8460@item Array Slice Values
8461An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
8462@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
8463@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
8464arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
8465which is part of the specified array.
8466
8467@item Structure Field Values
8468A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
8469name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
8470in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
8471corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
8472
8473@item Procedure Call Value
8474The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
8475procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
8476expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 8477effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 8478
d4f3574e 8479Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 8480
6d2ebf8b
SS
8481Values of time mode locations appear as
8482@smallexample
8483@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
8484@end smallexample
8485
cce74817
JM
8486
8487@ignore
8488This is not implemented yet:
8489@item Built-in Value
8490@noindent
8491The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 8492
cce74817
JM
8493@table @code
8494@item @code{ADDR()}
8495@item @code{NUM()}
8496@item @code{PRED()}
8497@item @code{SUCC()}
8498@item @code{ABS()}
8499@item @code{CARD()}
8500@item @code{MAX()}
8501@item @code{MIN()}
8502@item @code{SIZE()}
8503@item @code{UPPER()}
8504@item @code{LOWER()}
8505@item @code{LENGTH()}
8506@item @code{SIN()}
8507@item @code{COS()}
8508@item @code{TAN()}
8509@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8510@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8511@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8512@item @code{EXP()}
8513@item @code{LN()}
8514@item @code{LOG()}
8515@item @code{SQRT()}
8516@end table
8517
8518For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8519chapter 1.6.
8520@end ignore
8521
8522@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8523The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8524current active process.
8525
8526@item Expression Values
8527The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8528the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8529incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8530corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8531causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8532which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8533operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8534
cce74817
JM
8535@table @code
8536@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8537@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8538@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8539Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8540
cce74817
JM
8541@item @code{=, /=}
8542Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8543
cce74817 8544@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8545@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8546Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8547
cce74817 8548@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8549@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8550Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8551
cce74817
JM
8552@item @code{-}
8553Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8554
cce74817
JM
8555@item @code{//}
8556String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8557
cce74817
JM
8558@item @code{()}
8559String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8560
cce74817
JM
8561@item @code{->}
8562Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8563address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8564location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8565
cce74817 8566@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8567@itemx @code{AND}
8568@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8569Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8570
cce74817 8571@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8572@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8573Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8574
cce74817
JM
8575@item @code{IN}
8576Membership operator.
8577@end table
8578@end table
8579
6d2ebf8b 8580@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8581@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8582
8583@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8584of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8585complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8586equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8587structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8588
8589Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8590index bounds and all built in procedures.
8591
8592Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8593check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8594operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8595functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8596language specification.
8597
cce74817
JM
8598All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8599off}.
8600
5d161b24 8601@ignore
53a5351d 8602@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8603see last paragraph ?
8604@end ignore
8605
6d2ebf8b 8606@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8607@subsubsection Chill defaults
8608
8609If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8610both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8611Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8612selected the working language.
8613
8614If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8615code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8616working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8617the language automatically}, for further details.
8618
6d2ebf8b 8619@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8620@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8621
d4f3574e 8622The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8623symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8624program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8625does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8626program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8627(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8628file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8629
8630@cindex symbol names
8631@cindex names of symbols
8632@cindex quoting names
8633Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8634characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8635most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8636source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8637are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8638ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8639@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8640@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8641
8642@example
8643p 'foo.c'::x
8644@end example
8645
8646@noindent
8647looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8648
8649@table @code
8650@kindex info address
b37052ae 8651@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8652@item info address @var{symbol}
8653Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8654variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8655local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8656is always stored.
8657
8658Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8659at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8660the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8661
3d67e040 8662@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8663@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8664@item info symbol @var{addr}
8665Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8666If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8667nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8668
8669@example
8670(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8671_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8672@end example
8673
8674@noindent
8675This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8676it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8677
c906108c 8678@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8679@item whatis @var{expr}
8680Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8681actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8682assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8683@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8684
8685@item whatis
8686Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8687
8688@kindex ptype
8689@item ptype @var{typename}
8690Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8691the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8692@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8693@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8694
d4f3574e 8695@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8696@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8697Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8698differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8699of just the name of the type.
8700
8701For example, for this variable declaration:
8702
8703@example
8704struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8705@end example
8706
8707@noindent
8708the two commands give this output:
8709
8710@example
8711@group
8712(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8713type = struct complex
8714(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8715type = struct complex @{
8716 double real;
8717 double imag;
8718@}
8719@end group
8720@end example
8721
8722@noindent
8723As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8724the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8725
8726@kindex info types
8727@item info types @var{regexp}
8728@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8729Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8730(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8731complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8732@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8733names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8734information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8735
8736This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8737@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8738lists all source files where a type is defined.
8739
b37052ae
EZ
8740@kindex info scope
8741@cindex local variables
8742@item info scope @var{addr}
8743List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8744accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8745preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8746scope defined by that location. For example:
8747
8748@smallexample
8749(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8750Scope for command_line_handler:
8751Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8752Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8753Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8754Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8755Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8756Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8757Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8758@end smallexample
8759
f5c37c66
EZ
8760@noindent
8761This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8762during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8763collect}.
8764
c906108c
SS
8765@kindex info source
8766@item info source
8767Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8768the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8769it was written in.
8770
8771@kindex info sources
8772@item info sources
8773Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8774debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8775have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8776
8777@kindex info functions
8778@item info functions
8779Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8780
8781@item info functions @var{regexp}
8782Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8783whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8784Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8785include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8786start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8787that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8788@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8789
8790@kindex info variables
8791@item info variables
8792Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8793outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8794
8795@item info variables @var{regexp}
8796Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8797variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8798@var{regexp}.
8799
8800@ignore
8801This was never implemented.
8802@kindex info methods
8803@item info methods
8804@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8805The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8806methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8807specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8808C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8809from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8810@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8811which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8812@end ignore
8813
c906108c
SS
8814@cindex reloading symbols
8815Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8816be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8817in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8818running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8819@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8820
8821@table @code
8822@kindex set symbol-reloading
8823@item set symbol-reloading on
8824Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8825object file with a particular name is seen again.
8826
8827@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8828Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8829same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8830running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8831should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8832may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8833several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8834name.
c906108c
SS
8835
8836@kindex show symbol-reloading
8837@item show symbol-reloading
8838Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8839@end table
c906108c 8840
c906108c
SS
8841@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8842@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8843Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8844declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8845@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8846source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8847another source file. The default is on.
8848
8849A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8850the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8851
8852@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8853Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8854is printed as follows:
8855@smallexample
8856@{<no data fields>@}
8857@end smallexample
8858
8859@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8860@item show opaque-type-resolution
8861Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8862
8863@kindex maint print symbols
8864@cindex symbol dump
8865@kindex maint print psymbols
8866@cindex partial symbol dump
8867@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8868@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8869@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8870Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8871These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8872symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8873symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8874collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8875only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8876command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8877use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8878symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8879files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8880@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8881required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8882@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8883@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8884@end table
8885
6d2ebf8b 8886@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8887@chapter Altering Execution
8888
8889Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8890find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8891correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8892experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8893program.
8894
8895For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8896locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8897address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8898
8899@menu
8900* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8901* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8902* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8903* Returning:: Returning from a function
8904* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8905* Patching:: Patching your program
8906@end menu
8907
6d2ebf8b 8908@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8909@section Assignment to variables
8910
8911@cindex assignment
8912@cindex setting variables
8913To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8914@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8915
8916@example
8917print x=4
8918@end example
8919
8920@noindent
8921stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8922value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8923@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8924information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8925
8926@kindex set variable
8927@cindex variables, setting
8928If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8929@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8930really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8931not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8932,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8933
c906108c
SS
8934If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8935appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8936variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8937to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8938program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8939a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8940command @code{set width}:
8941
8942@example
8943(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8944type = double
8945(@value{GDBP}) p width
8946$4 = 13
8947(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8948Invalid syntax in expression.
8949@end example
8950
8951@noindent
8952The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8953order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8954
8955@example
8956(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8957@end example
53a5351d 8958
c906108c
SS
8959Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8960with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8961@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8962your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8963to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8964the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8965
8966@example
8967@group
8968(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8969type = double
8970(@value{GDBP}) p g
8971$1 = 1
8972(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8973(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8974$2 = 1
8975(@value{GDBP}) r
8976The program being debugged has been started already.
8977Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8978Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8979"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8980 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8981(@value{GDBP}) show g
8982The current BFD target is "=4".
8983@end group
8984@end example
8985
8986@noindent
8987The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8988@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8989@code{g}, use
8990
8991@example
8992(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8993@end example
c906108c
SS
8994
8995@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8996freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8997and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8998same length or shorter.
8999@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9000@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9001
9002To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9003construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9004(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9005to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9006and representation in memory), and
9007
9008@example
9009set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9010@end example
9011
9012@noindent
9013stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9014
6d2ebf8b 9015@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9016@section Continuing at a different address
9017
9018Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9019it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9020an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9021
9022@table @code
9023@kindex jump
9024@item jump @var{linespec}
9025Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9026immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9027source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9028@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9029in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9030breakpoints}.
9031
9032The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9033the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9034register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9035a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9036be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9037of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9038confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9039executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9040well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9041
9042@item jump *@var{address}
9043Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9044@end table
9045
c906108c 9046@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9047On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9048command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9049difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9050changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9051example,
c906108c
SS
9052
9053@example
9054set $pc = 0x485
9055@end example
9056
9057@noindent
9058makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9059address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9060@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9061
9062The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9063up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9064that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9065detail.
9066
c906108c 9067@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9068@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9069@section Giving your program a signal
9070
9071@table @code
9072@kindex signal
9073@item signal @var{signal}
9074Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9075signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9076signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9077SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9078
9079Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9080giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9081a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9082@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9083signal.
9084
9085@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9086after executing the command.
9087@end table
9088@c @end group
9089
9090Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9091@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9092causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9093the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9094passes the signal directly to your program.
9095
c906108c 9096
6d2ebf8b 9097@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9098@section Returning from a function
9099
9100@table @code
9101@cindex returning from a function
9102@kindex return
9103@item return
9104@itemx return @var{expression}
9105You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9106command. If you give an
9107@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9108value.
9109@end table
9110
9111When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9112(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9113discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9114be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9115
9116This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9117frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9118innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9119specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9120of functions.
9121
9122The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9123program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9124returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9125and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9126selected stack frame returns naturally.
9127
6d2ebf8b 9128@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9129@section Calling program functions
9130
9131@cindex calling functions
9132@kindex call
9133@table @code
9134@item call @var{expr}
9135Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9136returned values.
9137@end table
9138
9139You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9140execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9141with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9142is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9143
c906108c
SS
9144For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
9145specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
9146calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
9147method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
9148that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 9149
6d2ebf8b 9150@node Patching
c906108c 9151@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9152
c906108c
SS
9153@cindex patching binaries
9154@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9155@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9156
7a292a7a
SS
9157By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9158executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9159alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9160patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9161
9162If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9163explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9164want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9165repairs.
9166
9167@table @code
9168@kindex set write
9169@item set write on
9170@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9171If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9172core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9173off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9174
9175If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9176@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9177write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9178
9179@item show write
9180@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9181Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9182as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9183@end table
9184
6d2ebf8b 9185@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9186@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9187
7a292a7a
SS
9188@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9189both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9190program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9191@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9192
9193@menu
9194* Files:: Commands to specify files
9195* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9196@end menu
9197
6d2ebf8b 9198@node Files
c906108c 9199@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9200
7a292a7a 9201@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9202@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9203
9204You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9205way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9206@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9207Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9208
9209Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9210@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9211a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9212to specify new files are useful.
9213
9214@table @code
9215@cindex executable file
9216@kindex file
9217@item file @var{filename}
9218Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9219symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9220executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9221directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9222@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9223directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9224to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9225and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9226
6d2ebf8b 9227On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9228@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9229@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9230@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9231descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9232(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9233@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9234for more information.
c906108c
SS
9235
9236@item file
9237@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9238has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9239
9240@kindex exec-file
9241@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9242Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9243in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9244if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9245discard information on the executable file.
9246
9247@kindex symbol-file
9248@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9249Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9250searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9251table and program to run from the same file.
9252
9253@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9254program's symbol table.
9255
5d161b24 9256The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9257of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9258auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9259the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9260the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9261
9262@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9263executing it once.
9264
9265When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9266understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9267generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9268other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9269Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9270using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9271optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9272
9273For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9274using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9275symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9276quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9277details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9278
9279The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9280start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9281occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9282file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9283pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9284warnings and messages}.)
9285
c906108c
SS
9286We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9287symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9288symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9289still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9290in stabs format.
9291
9292@kindex readnow
9293@cindex reading symbols immediately
9294@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9295@kindex mapped
9296@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9297@cindex saving symbol table
9298@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9299@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9300You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9301tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9302load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9303entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9304
c906108c
SS
9305If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9306@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9307cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9308file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9309from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9310than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9311program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9312starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9313
9314You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9315file has all the symbol information for your program.
9316
9317The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9318@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9319than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9320it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9321needed.
9322
9323The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9324@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9325symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9326
9327@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9328@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9329@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9330@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9331@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9332@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9333@c files.
9334
9335@kindex core
9336@kindex core-file
9337@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9338Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9339of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9340address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9341executable file itself for other parts.
9342
9343@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9344to be used.
9345
9346Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9347under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9348wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9349the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9350(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9351
c906108c
SS
9352@kindex add-symbol-file
9353@cindex dynamic linking
9354@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9355@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9356@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9357The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9358information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9359when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9360into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9361address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9362this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9363of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9364section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9365@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9366
9367The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9368originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9369@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9370thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9371instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9372
17d9d558
JB
9373@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9374@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9375@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9376@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9377@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9378Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9379executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9380relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9381information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9382
9383@itemize @bullet
9384@item
9385the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9386that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9387@item
9388every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9389been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9390@item
9391you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9392provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9393@end itemize
9394
9395@noindent
9396Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9397relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9398typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9399important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9400procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9401assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9402general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9403relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9404as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9405way.
9406
c906108c
SS
9407@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9408
9409You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9410the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9411table information for @var{filename}.
9412
9413@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9414@item add-shared-symbol-file
9415The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9416operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9417shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9418@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9419
c906108c
SS
9420@kindex section
9421@item section
5d161b24
DB
9422The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9423the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9424section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9425specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9426separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9427the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9428
9429@kindex info files
9430@kindex info target
9431@item info files
9432@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9433@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9434current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9435including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9436use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9437command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9438current ones.
9439
fe95c787
MS
9440@kindex maint info sections
9441@item maint info sections
9442Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9443is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9444displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9445offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9446@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9447may be arbitrarily combined):
9448
9449@table @code
9450@item ALLOBJ
9451Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9452@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9453Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9454@item @var{section-flags}
9455Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9456The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9457@table @code
9458@item ALLOC
9459Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9460Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9461@item LOAD
9462Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9463Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9464@item RELOC
9465Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9466@item READONLY
9467Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9468@item CODE
9469Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9470@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9471Section contains data only (no executable code).
9472@item ROM
9473Section will reside in ROM.
9474@item CONSTRUCTOR
9475Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9476@item HAS_CONTENTS
9477Section is not empty.
9478@item NEVER_LOAD
9479An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9480@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9481A notification to the linker that the section contains
9482COFF shared library information.
9483@item IS_COMMON
9484Section contains common symbols.
9485@end table
9486@end table
c906108c
SS
9487@end table
9488
9489All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9490as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9491name and remembers it that way.
9492
c906108c 9493@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9494@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9495libraries.
53a5351d 9496
c906108c
SS
9497@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9498when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9499(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9500references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9501debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9502
9503On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9504automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9505
c906108c
SS
9506@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9507@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9508@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9509
b7209cb4
FF
9510There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9511symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9512particularly large or there are many of them.
9513
9514To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9515commands:
9516
9517@table @code
9518@kindex set auto-solib-add
9519@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9520If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9521will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9522attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9523informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9524is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9525@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9526
9527@kindex show auto-solib-add
9528@item show auto-solib-add
9529Display the current autoloading mode.
9530@end table
9531
9532To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9533command:
9534
c906108c
SS
9535@table @code
9536@kindex info sharedlibrary
9537@kindex info share
9538@item info share
9539@itemx info sharedlibrary
9540Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9541
9542@kindex sharedlibrary
9543@kindex share
9544@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9545@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9546Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9547Unix regular expression.
9548As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9549required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9550@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9551loaded.
9552@end table
9553
b7209cb4
FF
9554On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9555autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9556reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9557by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9558up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9559wish.
c906108c
SS
9560
9561Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9562loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9563@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9564automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9565
9566To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9567
9568@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9569@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9570@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9571Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9572If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9573symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9574size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9575Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
b7209cb4
FF
9576@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e. 100
9577Mb).
c906108c 9578
b7209cb4
FF
9579@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9580@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9581Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9582@end table
c906108c 9583
6d2ebf8b 9584@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9585@section Errors reading symbol files
9586
9587While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9588such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9589output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9590they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9591debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9592about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9593only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9594times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9595to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9596complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9597messages}).
9598
9599The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9600
9601@table @code
9602@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9603
9604The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9605(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9606error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9607in its outer scope blocks.
9608
9609@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9610the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9611may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9612function.
9613
9614@item block at @var{address} out of order
9615
9616The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9617order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9618do so.
9619
9620@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9621locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9622can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9623@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9624messages}.)
9625
9626@item bad block start address patched
9627
9628The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9629smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9630to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9631
9632@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9633starting on the previous source line.
9634
9635@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9636
9637@cindex foo
9638Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9639larger than the size of the string table.
9640
9641@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9642name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9643with this name.
9644
9645@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9646
7a292a7a
SS
9647The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9648not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9649uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9650
7a292a7a
SS
9651@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9652This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9653are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9654debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9655on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9656and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9657
9658@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9659
7a292a7a 9660@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9661
7a292a7a 9662@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9663The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9664information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9665it.
c906108c
SS
9666
9667@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9668
9669@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9670
c906108c
SS
9671@end table
9672
6d2ebf8b 9673@node Targets
c906108c 9674@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9675
c906108c
SS
9676@cindex debugging target
9677@kindex target
9678
9679A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9680
9681Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9682in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9683you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9684flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9685host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9686realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9687command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9688(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9689
9690@menu
9691* Active Targets:: Active targets
9692* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9693* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9694* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9695* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9696
9697@end menu
9698
6d2ebf8b 9699@node Active Targets
c906108c 9700@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9701
c906108c
SS
9702@cindex stacking targets
9703@cindex active targets
9704@cindex multiple targets
9705
c906108c 9706There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9707executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9708active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9709start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9710a core file.
c906108c
SS
9711
9712For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9713@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9714well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9715@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9716first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9717requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9718are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9719read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9720executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9721
9722When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9723target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9724commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9725an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9726process target is active.
c906108c 9727
7a292a7a
SS
9728Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9729core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9730files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9731the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9732process}).
c906108c 9733
6d2ebf8b 9734@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9735@section Commands for managing targets
9736
9737@table @code
9738@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9739Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9740process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9741facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9742protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9743
9744Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9745typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9746with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9747
9748The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9749after executing the command.
9750
9751@kindex help target
9752@item help target
9753Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9754currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9755(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9756
9757@item help target @var{name}
9758Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9759select it.
9760
9761@kindex set gnutarget
9762@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9763@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9764knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9765a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9766with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9767with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9768
d4f3574e 9769@quotation
c906108c
SS
9770@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9771you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9772@end quotation
c906108c 9773
d4f3574e
SS
9774@noindent
9775@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9776
5d161b24 9777@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9778@item show gnutarget
9779Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9780@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9781@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9782and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9783@end table
9784
c906108c
SS
9785Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9786configuration):
c906108c
SS
9787
9788@table @code
9789@kindex target exec
9790@item target exec @var{program}
9791An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9792@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9793
c906108c
SS
9794@kindex target core
9795@item target core @var{filename}
9796A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9797@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9798
9799@kindex target remote
9800@item target remote @var{dev}
9801Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9802specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9803@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9804supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9805some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9806it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9807
c906108c
SS
9808@kindex target sim
9809@item target sim
2df3850c 9810Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9811In general,
9812@example
9813 target sim
9814 load
9815 run
9816@end example
d4f3574e 9817@noindent
104c1213 9818works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9819drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9820provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9821see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9822Processors}.
9823
c906108c
SS
9824@end table
9825
104c1213 9826Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9827
9828@table @code
9829
c906108c
SS
9830@kindex target nrom
9831@item target nrom @var{dev}
9832NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9833
c906108c
SS
9834@end table
9835
5d161b24 9836Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9837your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9838
9839Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9840once you've successfully established a connection.
9841
9842@table @code
9843
9844@kindex load @var{filename}
9845@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9846Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9847@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9848is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9849on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9850@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9851the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9852
9853If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9854execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9855target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9856
9857The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9858For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9859link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9860specifies a fixed address.
9861@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9862
c906108c
SS
9863@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9864@end table
9865
6d2ebf8b 9866@node Byte Order
c906108c 9867@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9868
c906108c
SS
9869@cindex choosing target byte order
9870@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9871
9872Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9873offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9874orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9875designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9876which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9877@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9878
9879@table @code
9880@kindex set endian big
9881@item set endian big
9882Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9883
9884@kindex set endian little
9885@item set endian little
9886Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9887
9888@kindex set endian auto
9889@item set endian auto
9890Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9891executable.
9892
9893@item show endian
9894Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9895
9896@end table
9897
9898Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9899data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9900target system.
9901
6d2ebf8b 9902@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9903@section Remote debugging
9904@cindex remote debugging
9905
9906If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9907@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9908For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9909or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9910powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9911
9912Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9913to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9914@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9915but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9916write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9917communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9918
9919Other remote targets may be available in your
9920configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9921
c906108c 9922@menu
c906108c 9923* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
9924@end menu
9925
6d2ebf8b 9926@node Remote Serial
104c1213 9927@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 9928
104c1213
JM
9929@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9930To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9931@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9932prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9933program, you need:
c906108c 9934
104c1213
JM
9935@enumerate
9936@item
9937A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9938have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9939your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 9940
5d161b24 9941@item
d4f3574e 9942A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 9943subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 9944
104c1213
JM
9945@item
9946A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9947download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9948manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9949documentation.
9950@end enumerate
96baa820 9951
104c1213
JM
9952The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9953communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9954machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 9955
104c1213
JM
9956@table @emph
9957@item On the host,
9958@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9959else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9960(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9961
9962@item On the target,
9963you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9964implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9965subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9966
9967On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9968@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9969@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9970@end table
96baa820 9971
104c1213
JM
9972The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9973machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9974@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 9975
104c1213
JM
9976@cindex remote serial stub list
9977These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 9978
104c1213
JM
9979@table @code
9980
9981@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 9982@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9983@cindex Intel
9984@cindex i386
9985For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9986
9987@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 9988@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9989@cindex Motorola 680x0
9990@cindex m680x0
9991For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9992
9993@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 9994@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9995@cindex Hitachi
9996@cindex SH
9997For Hitachi SH architectures.
9998
9999@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10000@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10001@cindex Sparc
10002For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10003
10004@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10005@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10006@cindex Fujitsu
10007@cindex SparcLite
10008For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10009
10010@end table
10011
10012The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10013recently added stubs.
10014
10015@menu
10016* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10017* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10018* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
10019* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
10020* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
10021* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
10022@end menu
10023
6d2ebf8b 10024@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
10025@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
10026
10027@cindex remote serial stub
10028The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10029subroutines:
10030
10031@table @code
10032@item set_debug_traps
10033@kindex set_debug_traps
10034@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10035This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10036program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10037beginning of your program.
10038
10039@item handle_exception
10040@kindex handle_exception
10041@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10042This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10043explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10044run when a trap is triggered.
10045
10046@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10047execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10048with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10049protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10050representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10051information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10052retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10053execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10054@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10055machine.
104c1213
JM
10056
10057@item breakpoint
10058@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10059Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10060breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10061way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10062machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10063pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10064@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10065simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10066again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10067your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10068@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10069
10070Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10071to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10072start of your debugging session.
10073@end table
10074
6d2ebf8b 10075@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
10076@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
10077
10078@cindex remote stub, support routines
10079The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10080chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10081debugging target machine.
10082
10083First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10084serial port.
10085
10086@table @code
10087@item int getDebugChar()
10088@kindex getDebugChar
10089Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10090It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10091different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10092
10093@item void putDebugChar(int)
10094@kindex putDebugChar
10095Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10096It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10097different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10098@end table
10099
10100@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10101@cindex interrupting remote targets
10102If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10103running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10104for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10105character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10106remote system to stop.
10107
10108Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10109probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10110is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10111@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10112
10113Other routines you need to supply are:
10114
10115@table @code
10116@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10117@kindex exceptionHandler
10118Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10119handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10120way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10121are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10122containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10123@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10124its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10125might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10126exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10127@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10128and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10129you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10130should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10131
10132For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10133gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10134should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10135@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10136help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10137
10138@item void flush_i_cache()
10139@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10140On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10141instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10142instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10143
10144On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10145function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10146@end table
10147
10148@noindent
10149You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10150
10151@table @code
10152@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10153@kindex memset
10154This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10155memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10156@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10157either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10158@end table
10159
10160If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10161library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10162but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10163subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10164
10165
6d2ebf8b 10166@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
10167@subsubsection Putting it all together
10168
10169@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10170In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10171steps.
10172
10173@enumerate
10174@item
6d2ebf8b 10175Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10176(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10177@display
10178@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10179@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10180@end display
10181
10182@item
10183Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10184
10185@example
10186set_debug_traps();
10187breakpoint();
10188@end example
10189
10190@item
10191For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10192@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10193
10194@example
10195void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
10196@end example
10197
d4f3574e 10198@noindent
104c1213 10199but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10200function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10201@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10202error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10203one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10204
10205@item
10206Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10207your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10208
10209@item
10210Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10211the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10212
10213@item
10214@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10215@c document that. FIXME.
10216Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10217whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10218
10219@item
10220To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10221as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10222This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10223of its pure text.
10224
d4f3574e 10225@item
104c1213 10226@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10227Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10228Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10229machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
10230TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
10231to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10232device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10233
10234@example
10235target remote /dev/ttyb
10236@end example
10237
10238@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10239To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10240@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10241terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10242
10243@example
10244target remote manyfarms:2828
10245@end example
a2bea4c3
CV
10246
10247If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10248your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10249the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10250to port 1234 on your local machine:
10251
10252@example
10253target remote :1234
10254@end example
10255@noindent
10256
10257Note that the colon is still required here.
104c1213
JM
10258@end enumerate
10259
10260Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10261step and continue the remote program.
10262
10263To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10264command.
10265
10266@cindex interrupting remote programs
10267@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10268Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10269interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10270program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10271and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10272interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10273
10274@example
10275Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10276Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10277@end example
10278
10279If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10280(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10281remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10282goes back to waiting.
10283
6d2ebf8b 10284@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
10285@subsubsection Communication protocol
10286
10287@cindex debugging stub, example
10288@cindex remote stub, example
10289@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10290The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10291communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10292@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10293these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10294implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10295with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10296organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10297
10298However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
10299the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
10300target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
10301it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
10302
10303In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
10304transmitted and received data respectfully.
10305
10306@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
10307@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
10308@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
10309All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
10310sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
10311@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
10312@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
10313
10314@example
10315@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
10316@end example
10317@noindent
104c1213
JM
10318
10319@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
10320@noindent
10321The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
10322characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
10323eight bit unsigned checksum).
10324
10325Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
10326specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
10327
10328@example
10329@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
10330@end example
104c1213
JM
10331
10332@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
10333@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
10334That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
10335has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
10336since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 10337
6cf7e474 10338@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
10339When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
10340response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
10341the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
10342retransmission):
10343
10344@example
10345<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
10346-> @code{+}
10347@end example
10348@noindent
104c1213
JM
10349
10350The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
10351debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
10352the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
10353when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
10354
10355@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
10356exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
10357exceptions).
10358
10359Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
10360@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
10361HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
10362
10363Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
10364@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
10365would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
10366
10367Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 10368means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
10369which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
10370@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
10371where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
10372characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
10373value greater than 126 should not be used.
10374
10375Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
10376loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
10377character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
10378
10379So:
10380@example
10381"@code{0* }"
10382@end example
10383@noindent
10384means the same as "0000".
10385
598ca718 10386The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
10387error number. That number is not well defined.
10388
10389For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
10390(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
10391protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 10392on that response.
104c1213 10393
f1251bdd
C
10394A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
10395@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
10396optional.
10397
104c1213
JM
10398Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
10399their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 10400@page
104c1213
JM
10401@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
10402@item Packet
10403@tab Request
10404@tab Description
10405
df2396a1 10406@item extended mode
104c1213
JM
10407@tab @code{!}
10408@tab
df2396a1 10409Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
656db9b0 10410persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
df2396a1 10411debugged.
104c1213 10412@item
df2396a1 10413@tab reply @samp{OK}
104c1213 10414@tab
df2396a1 10415The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
104c1213
JM
10416
10417@item last signal
10418@tab @code{?}
10419@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10420Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
10421and continue.
10422@item
10423@tab reply
10424@tab see below
10425
104c1213
JM
10426
10427@item reserved
10428@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 10429@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10430
f1251bdd 10431@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
10432@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
10433@tab
598ca718
EZ
10434@item
10435@tab
10436@tab
104c1213
JM
10437Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
10438specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 10439See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
10440@item
10441@tab reply @code{OK}
10442@item
10443@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10444
10445@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
10446@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
10447@tab
10448Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
10449transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
10450transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
10451acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
10452to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
10453ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
10454specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
10455that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
10456happened.}
10457
10458@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
10459@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
10460@tab
10461Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
10462breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
10463@samp{z} packets.}
10464
10465@item continue
10466@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
10467@tab
10468@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10469current address.
10470@item
10471@tab reply
10472@tab see below
10473
f1251bdd 10474@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
10475@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10476@tab
10477Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
10478@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
10479@item
10480@tab reply
10481@tab see below
10482
598ca718 10483@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
10484@tab @code{d}
10485@tab
d4f3574e 10486toggle debug flag.
104c1213 10487
f1251bdd 10488@item detach
104c1213 10489@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 10490@tab
2df3850c
JM
10491Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
10492@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
10493@item
10494@tab reply @emph{no response}
10495@tab
598ca718 10496@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
10497
10498@item reserved
10499@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 10500@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10501
10502@item reserved
10503@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 10504@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10505
10506@item reserved
10507@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 10508@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10509
10510@item reserved
10511@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 10512@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10513
10514@item read registers
10515@tab @code{g}
10516@tab Read general registers.
10517@item
10518@tab reply @var{XX...}
10519@tab
10520Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
10521with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 10522each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 10523determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
10524@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
10525@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
10526@item
10527@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
10528@tab for an error.
10529
10530@item write regs
10531@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
10532@tab
10533See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
10534@item
10535@tab reply @code{OK}
10536@tab for success
10537@item
10538@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10539@tab for an error
10540
10541@item reserved
10542@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 10543@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10544
f1251bdd 10545@item set thread
104c1213
JM
10546@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
10547@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10548Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
10549@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
10550continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
10551thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
10552@item
10553@tab reply @code{OK}
10554@tab for success
10555@item
10556@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10557@tab for an error
10558
d4f3574e
SS
10559@c FIXME: JTC:
10560@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 10561@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
10562@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
10563@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
10564@c described. For example:
10565@c
10566@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
10567@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
10568@c otherwise returns current registers.
10569@c
10570@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
10571@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
10572@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
10573
f1251bdd 10574@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10575@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
10576@tab
10577Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
10578present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
10579step starting at that address.
10580
f1251bdd 10581@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
10582@tab @code{I}
10583@tab
10584See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
10585
10586@item reserved
10587@tab @code{j}
10588@tab Reserved for future use
10589
10590@item reserved
10591@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 10592@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10593
f1251bdd 10594@item kill request
104c1213
JM
10595@tab @code{k}
10596@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10597FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
10598thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
10599
10600@item reserved
10601@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 10602@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10603
10604@item reserved
10605@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 10606@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10607
10608@item read memory
10609@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10610@tab
10611Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 10612Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
10613using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
10614transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
10615@item
10616@tab reply @var{XX...}
10617@tab
d4f3574e 10618@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 10619to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
10620sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
10621@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
10622@item
10623@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10624@tab @var{NN} is errno
10625
10626@item write mem
10627@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
10628@tab
10629Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10630@var{XX...} is the data.
10631@item
10632@tab reply @code{OK}
10633@tab for success
10634@item
10635@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10636@tab
10637for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10638written).
10639
10640@item reserved
10641@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 10642@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10643
10644@item reserved
10645@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 10646@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10647
10648@item reserved
10649@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 10650@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10651
10652@item reserved
10653@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 10654@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10655
10656@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10657@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10658@tab
10659See write register.
10660@item
10661@tab return @var{r....}
10662@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10663
f1251bdd 10664@item write reg
104c1213
JM
10665@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10666@tab
10667Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10668digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10669@item
10670@tab reply @code{OK}
10671@tab for success
10672@item
10673@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10674@tab for an error
10675
f1251bdd 10676@item general query
104c1213
JM
10677@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10678@tab
598ca718 10679Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 10680have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
10681company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10682optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10683must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
10684@item
10685@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 10686@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
10687@item
10688@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10689@tab error reply
10690@item
10691@tab reply @samp{}
10692@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10693
f1251bdd 10694@item general set
104c1213
JM
10695@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10696@tab
10697Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10698naming conventions.
10699
598ca718 10700@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
10701@tab @code{r}
10702@tab
10703Reset the entire system.
104c1213 10704
f1251bdd 10705@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
10706@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10707@tab
df2396a1
AC
10708Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
10709This packet is only available in extended mode.
10710@item
10711@tab
10712no reply
10713@tab
10714The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
104c1213 10715
f1251bdd 10716@item step
104c1213
JM
10717@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10718@tab
10719@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10720same address.
10721@item
10722@tab reply
10723@tab see below
10724
f1251bdd 10725@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
10726@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10727@tab
10728Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10729@item
10730@tab reply
10731@tab see below
10732
f1251bdd 10733@item search
104c1213
JM
10734@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10735@tab
10736Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10737@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 10738bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 10739
f1251bdd 10740@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
10741@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10742@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10743@item
10744@tab reply @code{OK}
10745@tab thread is still alive
10746@item
10747@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10748@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 10749
104c1213
JM
10750@item reserved
10751@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 10752@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10753
10754@item reserved
10755@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 10756@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10757
10758@item reserved
10759@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 10760@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10761
10762@item reserved
10763@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 10764@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10765
10766@item reserved
10767@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 10768@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10769
10770@item reserved
10771@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 10772@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10773
10774@item reserved
10775@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 10776@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10777
f1251bdd 10778@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
10779@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10780@tab
10781@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
10782binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10783escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
10784@item
10785@tab reply @code{OK}
10786@tab for success
10787@item
10788@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10789@tab for an error
10790
10791@item reserved
10792@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 10793@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10794
10795@item reserved
10796@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 10797@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10798
f1251bdd 10799@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10800@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10801@tab
10802See @samp{Z}.
10803
f1251bdd 10804@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10805@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10806@tab
10807@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10808breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10809@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10810bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10811the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
10812@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10813potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 10814implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
10815@item
10816@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10817@tab for an error
10818@item
10819@tab reply @code{OK}
10820@tab for success
10821@item
10822@tab @samp{}
10823@tab If not supported.
10824
10825@item reserved
10826@tab <other>
5d161b24 10827@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10828
10829@end multitable
10830
d4f3574e
SS
10831The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10832receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10833@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10834when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10835number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10836conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
10837
10838@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10839
10840@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10841@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10842
10843@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10844@tab
10845@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10846(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10847by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10848thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 10849starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
10850@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10851extend the protocol.
10852
10853@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10854@tab
10855The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10856applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10857
10858@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10859@tab
10860The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10861
6d2ebf8b 10862@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 10863@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
10864@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10865@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10866@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10867this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10868spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10869debugger.}
104c1213
JM
10870
10871@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10872@tab
c3f6f71d 10873@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
10874while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10875for 'W', 'T', etc.
10876
10877@end multitable
10878
d4f3574e
SS
10879The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10880
10881@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10882
10883@item current thread
10884@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10885@tab Return the current thread id.
10886@item
10887@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10888@tab
10889Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10890@item
10891@tab reply *
10892@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10893
bba2971c
MS
10894@item all thread ids
10895@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10896@item
10897@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 10898@tab
bba2971c
MS
10899Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10900may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10901works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10902obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 10903be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 10904sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 10905@item
bba2971c
MS
10906@tab
10907@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 10908@item
5d161b24 10909@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
10910@tab A single thread id
10911@item
00e4a2e4 10912@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
10913@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10914@item
10915@tab reply @code{l}
10916@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10917@item
10918@tab
10919@tab
10920In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10921or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10922respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10923@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10924(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10925
10926@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 10927@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
10928@tab
10929@item
10930@tab
10931@tab
10932Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10933Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10934the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10935thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10936The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 10937Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
10938"Blocked on Mutex".
10939@item
10940@tab reply @var{XX...}
10941@tab
10942Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10943printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10944attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
10945
10946@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10947@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10948@tab
2b628194
MS
10949@item
10950@tab
10951@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10952Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10953digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10954subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10955number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10956(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10957returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10958@item
bba2971c
MS
10959@tab
10960@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10961query (see above).
10962@item
d4f3574e
SS
10963@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10964@tab
2b628194
MS
10965@item
10966@tab
10967@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10968Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10969returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10970and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10971digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10972a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10973digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10974
bba2971c
MS
10975@item compute CRC of memory block
10976@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10977@tab
10978@item
10979@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10980@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10981@item
10982@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10983@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10984
d4f3574e
SS
10985@item query sect offs
10986@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
10987@tab
10988Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10989image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10990response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10991offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
10992@item
10993@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10994
10995@item thread info request
10996@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10997@tab
598ca718
EZ
10998@item
10999@tab
11000@tab
d4f3574e
SS
11001Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
11002encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
11003@item
11004@tab reply *
11005@tab
11006See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
11007
11008@item remote command
11009@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
11010@tab
598ca718
EZ
11011@item
11012@tab
11013@tab
d4f3574e
SS
11014@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
11015execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
11016Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
11017number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
11018packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
11019stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
11020@item
11021@tab reply @code{OK}
11022@tab
11023A command response with no output.
11024@item
11025@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
11026@tab
11027A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
11028@item
11029@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
11030@tab
11031Indicate a badly formed request.
11032
11033@item
11034@tab reply @samp{}
11035@tab
11036When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
11037
0f1f2b0a
MS
11038@item symbol lookup
11039@tab @code{qSymbol::}
11040@tab
11041Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
11042requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
11043@item
11044@tab
11045@tab
11046@item
11047@tab reply @code{OK}
11048@tab
11049The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
11050@item
11051@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
11052@tab
11053The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
11054@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
11055@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
11056message, described below.
11057
11058@item symbol value
11059@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
11060@tab
11061Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
11062@item
11063@tab
11064@tab
11065@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
11066the target has previously requested.
11067@item
11068@tab
11069@tab
11070@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
11071If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
11072field will be empty.
11073@item
11074@tab reply @code{OK}
11075@tab
11076The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
11077@item
11078@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
11079@tab
11080The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
11081@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
11082until the target ceases to request them.
11083
d4f3574e
SS
11084@end multitable
11085
11086The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
11087In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
11088bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
11089space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
11090The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
11091least-significant.
11092
11093@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
11094
11095@item MIPS32
11096@tab
11097All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1109832 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
11099registers; fsr; fir; fp.
11100
11101@item MIPS64
11102@tab
11103All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
11104thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
11105as @code{MIPS32}.
11106
11107@end multitable
11108
104c1213
JM
11109Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
11110does not get any direct output:
11111
11112@example
11113<- @code{R00}
11114-> @code{+}
11115@emph{target restarts}
11116<- @code{?}
11117-> @code{+}
11118-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
11119<- @code{+}
11120@end example
11121
11122Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
11123
11124@example
11125<- @code{G1445...}
11126-> @code{+}
11127<- @code{s}
11128-> @code{+}
11129@emph{time passes}
11130-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
11131<- @code{+}
11132<- @code{g}
11133-> @code{+}
11134-> @code{1455...}
11135<- @code{+}
11136@end example
11137
6d2ebf8b 11138@node Server
104c1213
JM
11139@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
11140
11141@kindex gdbserver
11142@cindex remote connection without stubs
11143@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
11144allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
11145@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
11146
11147@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
11148because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
11149that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
11150@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
11151@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
11152because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
11153also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
11154started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
11155Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
11156the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
11157do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
11158by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
11159choice for debugging.
11160
11161@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
11162or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
11163protocol.
11164
11165@table @emph
11166@item On the target machine,
11167you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
11168@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
11169strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
11170system does all the symbol handling.
11171
11172To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
11173the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
11174syntax is:
11175
11176@smallexample
11177target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
11178@end smallexample
11179
11180@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
11181hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
11182@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
11183@file{/dev/com1}:
11184
11185@smallexample
11186target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
11187@end smallexample
11188
11189@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
11190with it.
11191
11192To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
11193
11194@smallexample
11195target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
11196@end smallexample
11197
11198The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
11199specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
11200TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
11201expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
11202(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
11203you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
11204TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
11205reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
11206conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 11207and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
11208@code{target remote} command.
11209
11210@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
11211you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
11212symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
11213using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
11214(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 11215running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
11216remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
11217is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
11218@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
11219@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
11220
11221@smallexample
11222(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
11223@end smallexample
11224
11225@noindent
11226communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
11227
11228@smallexample
11229(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
11230@end smallexample
11231
11232@noindent
11233communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
11234For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
11235the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
11236text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
11237@samp{Connection refused}.
11238@end table
11239
6d2ebf8b 11240@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
11241@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
11242
11243@kindex gdbserve.nlm
11244@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
11245allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
11246@code{target remote}.
11247
11248@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
11249using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
11250
11251@table @emph
11252@item On the target machine,
11253you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
11254@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
11255can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
11256host system does all the symbol handling.
11257
11258To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
11259@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
11260program. The syntax is:
11261
5d161b24 11262@smallexample
104c1213
JM
11263load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
11264 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
11265@end smallexample
11266
11267@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
11268the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 11269to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
11270
11271For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 11272communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 11273using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
11274
11275@smallexample
11276load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
11277@end smallexample
11278
11279@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
11280you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
11281symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
11282using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
11283(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 11284running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
11285remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
11286argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
11287@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
11288
11289@smallexample
11290(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
11291@end smallexample
11292
11293@noindent
11294communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
11295@end table
11296
6d2ebf8b 11297@node KOD
104c1213
JM
11298@section Kernel Object Display
11299
11300@cindex kernel object display
11301@cindex kernel object
11302@cindex KOD
11303
11304Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
11305@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
11306and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
11307mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
11308displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
11309
11310Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
11311@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
11312
11313@example
2df3850c 11314(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
11315@end example
11316
11317If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
11318about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
11319which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
11320after the operating system:
11321
11322@example
2df3850c 11323(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
11324List of Cisco Kernel Objects
11325Object Description
11326any Any and all objects
11327@end example
11328
11329Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
11330by the kernel.
11331
11332There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
11333is supported other than to try it.
11334
11335
6d2ebf8b 11336@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
11337@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
11338
11339While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
11340cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
11341describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
11342
11343There are three major categories of configurations: native
11344configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
11345operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
11346different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
11347are quite different from each other.
11348
11349@menu
11350* Native::
11351* Embedded OS::
11352* Embedded Processors::
11353* Architectures::
11354@end menu
11355
6d2ebf8b 11356@node Native
104c1213
JM
11357@section Native
11358
11359This section describes details specific to particular native
11360configurations.
11361
11362@menu
11363* HP-UX:: HP-UX
11364* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9f20bf26 11365* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
104c1213
JM
11366@end menu
11367
6d2ebf8b 11368@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
11369@subsection HP-UX
11370
11371On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11372begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11373name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
11374
6d2ebf8b 11375@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
11376@subsection SVR4 process information
11377
11378@kindex /proc
11379@cindex process image
11380
11381Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11382used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11383subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11384this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11385several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11386@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11387@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
11388and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
11389
11390@table @code
11391@kindex info proc
11392@item info proc
11393Summarize available information about the process.
11394
11395@kindex info proc mappings
11396@item info proc mappings
11397Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11398on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
f6680716
MS
11399@ignore
11400@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11401@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11402@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
104c1213
JM
11403@kindex info proc times
11404@item info proc times
11405Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11406its children.
11407
11408@kindex info proc id
11409@item info proc id
11410Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11411the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
11412
11413@kindex info proc status
11414@item info proc status
11415General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11416stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11417received.
11418
11419@item info proc all
11420Show all the above information about the process.
f6680716 11421@end ignore
104c1213
JM
11422@end table
11423
9f20bf26
EZ
11424@node DJGPP Native
11425@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11426@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11427@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11428@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
11429
11430@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11431MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11432that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11433top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
11434
11435@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11436defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11437subsection describes those commands.
11438
11439@table @code
11440@kindex info dos
11441@item info dos
11442This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11443information about the target system and important OS structures.
11444
11445@kindex sysinfo
11446@cindex MS-DOS system info
11447@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11448@item info dos sysinfo
11449This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11450platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11451DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
11452
11453@cindex GDT
11454@cindex LDT
11455@cindex IDT
11456@cindex segment descriptor tables
11457@cindex descriptor tables display
11458@item info dos gdt
11459@itemx info dos ldt
11460@itemx info dos idt
11461These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11462and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11463tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11464that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11465descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11466descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11467rights.
11468
11469A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11470segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11471allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11472conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11473additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
11474
11475@cindex garbled pointers
11476These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11477Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11478displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11479display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11480example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11481debugged program's data segment:
11482
11483@smallexample
11484(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds
114850x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)
11486@end smallexample
11487
11488@noindent
11489This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11490the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
11491
11492@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11493@item info dos pde
11494@itemx info dos pte
11495These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11496Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11497data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11498into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11499page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11500may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11501Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11502that is currently in use.
11503
11504Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11505Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11506the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11507@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11508Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11509means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11510the specified entry in the Page Directory.
11511
11512These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11513Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11514controller.
11515
11516These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
11517
11518@cindex physical address from linear address
11519@item info dos address-pte
11520This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11521address. The argument linear address should already have the
11522appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11523accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11524example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11525the variable @code{i} is stored:
11526
11527@smallexample
11528(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i
11529Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:
11530Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30
11531@end smallexample
11532
11533@noindent
11534This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11535whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11536attributes of that page.
11537
11538Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11539since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11540address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11541be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11542declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11543@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11544
11545Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11546transfer buffer:
11547
11548@smallexample
11549(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)
11550Page Table entry for address 0x29110:
11551Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110
11552@end smallexample
11553
11554@noindent
11555(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
115563rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11557this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11558mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11559
11560This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11561@end table
11562
6d2ebf8b 11563@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
11564@section Embedded Operating Systems
11565
11566This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11567embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11568architectures.
11569
11570@menu
11571* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11572@end menu
11573
11574@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11575various real-time operating systems.
11576
6d2ebf8b 11577@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
11578@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11579
11580@cindex VxWorks
11581
11582@table @code
11583
11584@kindex target vxworks
11585@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11586A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11587is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11588
11589@end table
11590
11591On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11592current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11593
11594@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11595VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11596the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11597both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 11598@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 11599installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 11600@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
11601
11602@table @code
11603@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11604@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
11605All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11606This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11607seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11608your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
11609of a thin network line.
11610@end table
11611
11612The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11613this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11614procedures.
11615
11616@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11617To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11618to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11619library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11620VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11621kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11622source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11623information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11624manual.
11625@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11626
11627Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11628your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
11629run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11630@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
11631
11632@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11633
11634@example
11635(vxgdb)
11636@end example
11637
11638@menu
11639* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11640* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11641* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11642@end menu
11643
6d2ebf8b 11644@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
11645@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11646
11647The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11648network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11649
11650@example
11651(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11652@end example
11653
11654@need 750
11655@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11656
11657@smallexample
5d161b24 11658Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
11659Connected to tt.
11660@end smallexample
11661
11662@need 1000
11663@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11664loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11665these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11666path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11667to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11668
11669@example
11670prog.o: No such file or directory.
11671@end example
11672
11673When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11674the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11675command again.
11676
6d2ebf8b 11677@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
11678@subsubsection VxWorks download
11679
11680@cindex download to VxWorks
11681If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11682object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11683@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11684incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11685command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11686to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11687table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11688the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11689filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11690Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11691to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11692the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11693@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11694and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11695program, type this on VxWorks:
11696
11697@example
11698-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11699@end example
d4f3574e
SS
11700
11701@noindent
104c1213
JM
11702Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11703
11704@example
5d161b24 11705(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
11706(vxgdb) load prog.o
11707@end example
11708
11709@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11710
11711@smallexample
11712Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11713@end smallexample
11714
11715You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11716after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11717this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11718auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11719history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 11720debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
11721table.)
11722
6d2ebf8b 11723@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
11724@subsubsection Running tasks
11725
11726@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11727You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11728follows:
11729
11730@example
11731(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11732@end example
11733
11734@noindent
11735where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11736or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11737the time of attachment.
11738
6d2ebf8b 11739@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11740@section Embedded Processors
11741
11742This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11743configurations.
11744
11745@menu
11746* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
11747* ARM:: ARM
11748* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11749* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11750* i960:: Intel i960
11751* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11752* M68K:: Motorola M68K
11753* M88K:: Motorola M88K
11754* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11755* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11756* PowerPC: PowerPC
11757* SH:: Hitachi SH
11758* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11759* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11760* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11761* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11762@end menu
11763
6d2ebf8b 11764@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
11765@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
11766
11767@menu
11768* A29K UDI::
11769* A29K EB29K::
11770* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
11771* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
11772* Remote Log:: Remote log
11773@end menu
11774
11775@table @code
11776
11777@kindex target adapt
11778@item target adapt @var{dev}
11779Adapt monitor for A29K.
11780
11781@kindex target amd-eb
11782@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11783@cindex AMD EB29K
11784Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11785@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11786@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11787name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11788@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11789
11790@end table
11791
6d2ebf8b 11792@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
11793@subsubsection A29K UDI
11794
11795@cindex UDI
11796@cindex AMD29K via UDI
11797
11798@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11799protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
11800configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11801program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
11802use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11803@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11804
11805@table @code
11806@item target udi @var{keyword}
11807@kindex udi
11808Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11809@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11810This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11811connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11812working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11813to its pathname.
11814@end table
11815
6d2ebf8b 11816@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
11817@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11818
11819@cindex EB29K board
11820@cindex running 29K programs
11821
11822AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11823with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11824term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11825@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11826must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11827board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11828assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11829@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11830
6d2ebf8b 11831@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
11832@subsubsection Communications setup
11833
11834The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11835in DOS on the PC:
11836
11837@example
11838C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11839@end example
11840
11841@noindent
11842This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11843bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11844you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11845end of the connection as well.
11846@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 11847@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11848@c
11849@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11850@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11851@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11852@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11853@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
11854
11855To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11856the following at the DOS console:
11857
11858@example
11859C:\> CTTY com1
11860@end example
11861
11862@noindent
11863(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11864the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 11865had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
11866
11867From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11868@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11869
11870@example
11871cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11872@end example
11873
11874@noindent
11875The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11876serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11877may look something like the following:
11878
11879@example
11880tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11881@end example
11882
11883@noindent
11884Your system may require a different name where we show
11885@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11886parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11887@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11888system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11889@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11890@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11891@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11892@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11893@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11894@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11895@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11896@c
11897@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11898@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11899@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
11900
11901@kindex EBMON
11902Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11903directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11904start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11905with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11906@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11907@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11908
11909@example
11910C:\> G:
11911
11912G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11913
11914G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11915Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11916Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11917Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11918
11919Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11920
11921PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11922I/O Base = 0x208
11923Memory Base = 0xd0000
11924
11925Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11926Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11927Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11928
11929PageSize = 0x400
11930Register Stack Size = 0x800
11931Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11932
11933CPU PRL = 0x3
11934Am29027 Available = No
11935Byte Write Available = Yes
11936
11937# ~.
11938@end example
11939
11940Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11941typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11942running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11943
11944For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11945way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 11946system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
11947PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11948something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11949other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11950from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11951serial line.
11952
6d2ebf8b 11953@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
11954@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11955
11956Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11957program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11958name of your 29K program:
11959
11960@example
11961cd /usr/joe/work29k
11962@value{GDBP} myfoo
11963@end example
11964
11965@need 500
11966Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11967
11968@example
11969target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11970@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11971@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11972@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11973@end example
11974
11975@noindent
11976In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11977@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11978@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11979In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11980a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11981the name on the Unix side.
11982
11983At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11984to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11985@code{run}.
11986
11987To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11988command.
11989
11990To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11991once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11992@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11993@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 11994Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
11995and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11996
6d2ebf8b 11997@node Remote Log
104c1213 11998@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 11999@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
12000@cindex log file for EB29K
12001
12002The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
12003current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
12004@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
12005of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
12006another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
12007unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
12008
6d2ebf8b 12009@node ARM
104c1213
JM
12010@subsection ARM
12011
12012@table @code
12013
12014@kindex target rdi
12015@item target rdi @var{dev}
12016ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
12017use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
12018monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 12019
104c1213
JM
12020@kindex target rdp
12021@item target rdp @var{dev}
12022ARM Demon monitor.
12023
12024@end table
12025
6d2ebf8b 12026@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
12027@subsection Hitachi H8/300
12028
12029@table @code
12030
d4f3574e 12031@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
12032@item target hms @var{dev}
12033A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
12034Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
12035line and the communications speed used.
12036
d4f3574e 12037@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
12038@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12039E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
12040
d4f3574e
SS
12041@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
12042@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 12043@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 12044@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
12045Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12046
12047@end table
12048
12049@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
12050@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
12051@cindex download to Hitachi SH
12052@cindex Hitachi SH download
12053When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
12054board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
12055board and also opens it as the current executable target for
12056@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
12057
12058@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 12059Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
12060
12061@enumerate
12062@item
12063that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
12064for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
12065emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 12066the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
12067H8/300, or H8/500.)
12068
12069@item
12070what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
12071serial device available on your host is the default).
12072
12073@item
12074what speed to use over the serial device.
12075@end enumerate
12076
12077@menu
12078* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
12079* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
12080* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
12081@end menu
12082
6d2ebf8b 12083@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
12084@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
12085
12086@c only for Unix hosts
12087@kindex device
12088@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 12089Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
12090need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
12091first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
12092hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
12093
12094@kindex speed
12095@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 12096@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 12097speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 12098hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
12099the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
12100@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
12101
12102The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
12103use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
12104use a DOS host,
12105@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
12106called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
12107through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
12108to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
12109
12110The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
12111program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
12112sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
12113the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
12114
12115First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
12116board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
12117port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
12118When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 12119debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
12120for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
12121@code{COM2}.
12122
12123@example
12124C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
12125C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
12126
12127Resident portion of MODE loaded
12128
12129COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
12130
12131@end example
12132
12133@quotation
12134@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
12135@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
12136disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
12137your development board.
12138@end quotation
12139
d4f3574e 12140@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
12141Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
12142connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 12143the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
12144you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
12145commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
12146cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
12147download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
12148the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
12149(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
12150executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
12151@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
12152itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
12153
12154@smallexample
12155(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 12156@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 12157 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 12158 the conditions.
5d161b24 12159There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 12160for details.
2df3850c
JM
12161@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
12162(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 12163Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 12164(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
12165.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
12166.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
12167.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
12168@end smallexample
12169
12170At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
12171you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
12172sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
12173@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
12174resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
12175@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
12176
12177Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
12178available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
12179you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
12180
12181Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
12182@itemize @bullet
12183@item
12184to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
12185no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
12186
12187@item
12188to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
12189normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
12190to detect program completion.
12191@end itemize
12192
12193In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
12194development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
12195
6d2ebf8b 12196@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
12197@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
12198
d4f3574e 12199@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
12200You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
12201Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
12202e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
12203
12204@table @code
12205@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
12206Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
12207@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
12208@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
12209(for example, @samp{9600}).
12210
12211@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
12212If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
12213specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
12214@end table
12215
6d2ebf8b 12216@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
12217@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
12218
12219Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
12220
12221@table @code
12222
12223@kindex set machine
12224@kindex show machine
12225@item set machine h8300
12226@itemx set machine h8300h
12227Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
12228architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
12229to check which variant is currently in effect.
12230
12231@end table
12232
6d2ebf8b 12233@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
12234@subsection H8/500
12235
12236@table @code
12237
12238@kindex set memory @var{mod}
12239@cindex memory models, H8/500
12240@item set memory @var{mod}
12241@itemx show memory
12242Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
12243@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
12244memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
12245@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
12246
12247@end table
12248
6d2ebf8b 12249@node i960
104c1213
JM
12250@subsection Intel i960
12251
12252@table @code
12253
12254@kindex target mon960
12255@item target mon960 @var{dev}
12256MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
12257
f0ca3dce 12258@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
12259@item target nindy @var{devicename}
12260An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
12261the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
12262@file{/dev/ttya}.
12263
12264@end table
12265
12266@cindex Nindy
12267@cindex i960
12268@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
12269@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
12270tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
12271
12272@itemize @bullet
12273@item
12274Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
12275Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
12276
12277@item
12278By responding to a prompt on startup;
12279
12280@item
12281By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
12282session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
12283
104c1213
JM
12284@end itemize
12285
12286@cindex download to Nindy-960
12287With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
12288downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
12289@value{GDBN}.
12290
12291@menu
12292* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
12293* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
12294* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
12295@end menu
12296
6d2ebf8b 12297@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
12298@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
12299
12300If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
12301options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
12302reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
12303
12304@example
5d161b24 12305Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
12306@end example
12307
12308@noindent
12309Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
12310identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
12311simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
12312with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
12313use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
12314
6d2ebf8b 12315@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
12316@subsubsection Options for Nindy
12317
12318These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
12319Nindy-960 board attached:
12320
12321@table @code
12322@item -r @var{port}
12323Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
12324to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
12325configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
12326@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
12327device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
12328suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
12329
12330@item -O
12331(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
12332the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
12333This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
12334target architecture.
12335
12336@quotation
12337@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
12338connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
12339fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
12340attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
12341this process with an interrupt.
12342@end quotation
12343
12344@item -brk
12345Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
12346system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
12347
12348@quotation
12349@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
12350requires; it only works with a few boards.
12351@end quotation
12352@end table
12353
12354The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
12355port.
12356
12357@c @group
6d2ebf8b 12358@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
12359@subsubsection Nindy reset command
12360
12361@table @code
12362@item reset
12363@kindex reset
12364For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
12365system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
12366circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
12367a break is detected.
12368@end table
12369@c @end group
12370
6d2ebf8b 12371@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
12372@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
12373
12374@table @code
12375
12376@kindex target m32r
12377@item target m32r @var{dev}
12378Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
12379
12380@end table
12381
6d2ebf8b 12382@node M68K
104c1213
JM
12383@subsection M68k
12384
12385The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
12386target command for the following ROM monitors.
12387
12388@table @code
12389
12390@kindex target abug
12391@item target abug @var{dev}
12392ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
12393
12394@kindex target cpu32bug
12395@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
12396CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12397
12398@kindex target dbug
12399@item target dbug @var{dev}
12400dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
12401
12402@kindex target est
12403@item target est @var{dev}
12404EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12405
12406@kindex target rom68k
12407@item target rom68k @var{dev}
12408ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
12409
12410@end table
12411
12412If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
12413instead have only a single special target command:
12414
12415@table @code
12416
12417@kindex target es1800
12418@item target es1800 @var{dev}
12419ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
12420
12421@end table
12422
12423[context?]
12424
12425@table @code
12426
12427@kindex target rombug
12428@item target rombug @var{dev}
12429ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
12430
12431@end table
12432
6d2ebf8b 12433@node M88K
104c1213
JM
12434@subsection M88K
12435
12436@table @code
12437
12438@kindex target bug
12439@item target bug @var{dev}
12440BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
12441
12442@end table
12443
6d2ebf8b 12444@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
12445@subsection MIPS Embedded
12446
12447@cindex MIPS boards
12448@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
12449MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
12450you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
12451
12452@need 1000
12453Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
12454
12455@table @code
12456@item target mips @var{port}
12457@kindex target mips @var{port}
12458To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
12459name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
12460command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
12461the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
12462been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
12463download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
12464
12465For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
12466port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
12467debugger:
12468
12469@example
12470host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
12471@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
12472(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
12473(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
12474(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
12475@end example
12476
12477@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
12478On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
12479connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
12480concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
12481@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12482
12483@item target pmon @var{port}
12484@kindex target pmon @var{port}
12485PMON ROM monitor.
12486
12487@item target ddb @var{port}
12488@kindex target ddb @var{port}
12489NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
12490
12491@item target lsi @var{port}
12492@kindex target lsi @var{port}
12493LSI variant of PMON.
12494
12495@kindex target r3900
12496@item target r3900 @var{dev}
12497Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
12498
12499@kindex target array
12500@item target array @var{dev}
12501Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
12502
12503@end table
12504
12505
12506@noindent
12507@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
12508
12509@table @code
12510@item set processor @var{args}
12511@itemx show processor
12512@kindex set processor @var{args}
12513@kindex show processor
12514Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
12515processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 12516For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 12517to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 12518Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 12519is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 12520@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
12521
12522@item set mipsfpu double
12523@itemx set mipsfpu single
12524@itemx set mipsfpu none
12525@itemx show mipsfpu
12526@kindex set mipsfpu
12527@kindex show mipsfpu
12528@cindex MIPS remote floating point
12529@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12530If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12531coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 12532need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
12533file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12534functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12535@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12536functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12537with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12538processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12539double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12540@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
12541
12542In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12543floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12544and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
12545
12546As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12547@samp{show mipsfpu}.
12548
12549@item set remotedebug @var{n}
12550@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
12551@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12552@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
12553@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12554@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12555@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12556@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12557You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12558by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12559@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12560to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12561at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
12562
12563@item set timeout @var{seconds}
12564@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12565@itemx show timeout
12566@itemx show retransmit-timeout
12567@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12568@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12569@kindex set timeout
12570@kindex show timeout
12571@kindex set retransmit-timeout
12572@kindex show retransmit-timeout
12573You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12574remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12575default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12576waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12577retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12578You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12579retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12580@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12581
12582The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12583is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12584forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12585to run before stopping.
12586@end table
12587
6d2ebf8b 12588@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
12589@subsection PowerPC
12590
12591@table @code
12592
12593@kindex target dink32
12594@item target dink32 @var{dev}
12595DINK32 ROM monitor.
12596
12597@kindex target ppcbug
12598@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12599@kindex target ppcbug1
12600@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12601PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12602
12603@kindex target sds
12604@item target sds @var{dev}
12605SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12606
12607@end table
12608
6d2ebf8b 12609@node PA
104c1213
JM
12610@subsection HP PA Embedded
12611
12612@table @code
12613
12614@kindex target op50n
12615@item target op50n @var{dev}
12616OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12617
12618@kindex target w89k
12619@item target w89k @var{dev}
12620W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12621
12622@end table
12623
6d2ebf8b 12624@node SH
104c1213
JM
12625@subsection Hitachi SH
12626
12627@table @code
12628
d4f3574e 12629@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
12630@item target hms @var{dev}
12631A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12632commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12633the communications speed used.
12634
d4f3574e 12635@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
12636@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12637E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
12638
d4f3574e
SS
12639@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12640@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
12641@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12642@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12643Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12644
12645@end table
12646
6d2ebf8b 12647@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
12648@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12649
12650@cindex Sparclet
12651
5d161b24
DB
12652@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12653Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
12654@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12655both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 12656@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
12657
12658@table @code
f0ca3dce 12659@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 12660@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
12661@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12662This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12663seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12664@end table
12665
41afff9a 12666@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 12667When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 12668information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 12669load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 12670@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
12671
12672@example
12673sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12674@end example
12675
d4f3574e 12676You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
12677
12678@example
12679sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12680@end example
12681
41afff9a 12682@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
12683Once you have set
12684your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 12685run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
12686(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12687
12688@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12689
12690@example
12691(gdbslet)
12692@end example
12693
12694@menu
12695* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12696* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12697* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 12698* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12699@end menu
12700
6d2ebf8b 12701@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
12702@subsubsection Setting file to debug
12703
12704The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12705
12706@example
12707(gdbslet) file prog
12708@end example
12709
12710@need 1000
12711@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12712@value{GDBN} locates
12713the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12714path.
12715If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12716files will be searched as well.
12717@value{GDBN} locates
12718the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12719path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12720If it fails
12721to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12722
12723@example
12724prog: No such file or directory.
12725@end example
12726
12727When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 12728the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
12729@code{target} command again.
12730
6d2ebf8b 12731@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
12732@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12733
12734The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12735To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12736
12737@example
12738(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12739Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 12740main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
12741@end example
12742
12743@need 750
12744@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12745
d4f3574e 12746@example
104c1213 12747Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 12748@end example
104c1213 12749
6d2ebf8b 12750@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
12751@subsubsection Sparclet download
12752
12753@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 12754Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
12755you can use the @value{GDBN}
12756@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12757The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12758command.
5d161b24 12759Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 12760address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
12761offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12762of each of the file's sections.
12763For instance, if the program
12764@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12765and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12766
12767@example
12768(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12769Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12770@end example
12771
5d161b24
DB
12772If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12773to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
12774to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12775
6d2ebf8b 12776@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
12777@subsubsection Running and debugging
12778
12779@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12780You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 12781commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
12782manual for the list of commands.
12783
12784@example
12785(gdbslet) b main
12786Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 12787(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
12788Starting program: prog
12789Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
127903 char *symarg = 0;
12791(gdbslet) step
127924 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 12793(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
12794@end example
12795
6d2ebf8b 12796@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12797@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12798
12799@table @code
12800
12801@kindex target sparclite
12802@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
12803Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12804You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12805For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
12806remote protocol.
12807
12808@end table
12809
6d2ebf8b 12810@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
12811@subsection Tandem ST2000
12812
2df3850c 12813@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
12814STDBUG protocol.
12815
12816To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12817manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12818
12819@example
12820target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12821@end example
12822
12823@noindent
12824to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12825the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12826ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12827connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12828concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12829
12830The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12831this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12832would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12833(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12834available on your host computer.
12835@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12836@c basically hearsay.
12837
12838@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12839These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12840environment:
12841
12842@table @code
12843@item st2000 @var{command}
12844@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12845@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12846@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12847Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12848manual for available commands.
12849
12850@item connect
12851@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12852Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12853you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12854sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12855@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12856@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12857@end table
12858
6d2ebf8b 12859@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
12860@subsection Zilog Z8000
12861
12862@cindex Z8000
12863@cindex simulator, Z8000
12864@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12865
12866When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12867a Z8000 simulator.
12868
12869For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12870unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12871segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12872appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12873
12874@table @code
12875@item target sim @var{args}
12876@kindex sim
d4f3574e 12877@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
12878Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12879options, specify them via @var{args}.
12880@end table
12881
12882@noindent
12883After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12884CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12885@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12886to run your program, and so on.
12887
d4f3574e
SS
12888As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12889(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12890additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12891
12892@table @code
12893
12894@item cycles
12895Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12896
12897@item insts
12898Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12899
12900@item time
12901Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12902
12903@end table
12904
12905You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12906conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12907conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12908simulated clock ticks.
12909
6d2ebf8b 12910@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
12911@section Architectures
12912
12913This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 12914all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
12915
12916@menu
12917* A29K::
12918* Alpha::
12919* MIPS::
12920@end menu
12921
6d2ebf8b 12922@node A29K
104c1213
JM
12923@subsection A29K
12924
12925@table @code
12926
12927@kindex set rstack_high_address
12928@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12929@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12930@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12931On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 12932@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
12933extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12934stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12935memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12936this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12937the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12938address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12939hexadecimal.
12940
12941@kindex show rstack_high_address
12942@item show rstack_high_address
12943Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12944processors.
12945
12946@end table
12947
6d2ebf8b 12948@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
12949@subsection Alpha
12950
12951See the following section.
12952
6d2ebf8b 12953@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
12954@subsection MIPS
12955
12956@cindex stack on Alpha
12957@cindex stack on MIPS
12958@cindex Alpha stack
12959@cindex MIPS stack
12960Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12961sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12962find the beginning of a function.
12963
12964@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12965To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12966@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12967you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12968commands:
12969
12970@table @code
00e4a2e4 12971@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
12972@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12973Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12974search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12975default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12976larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12977and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12978
12979@item show heuristic-fence-post
12980Display the current limit.
12981@end table
12982
12983@noindent
12984These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12985for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12986
12987
6d2ebf8b 12988@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
12989@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12990
53a5351d
JM
12991You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12992@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 12993data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 12994described here.
c906108c
SS
12995
12996@menu
12997* Prompt:: Prompt
12998* Editing:: Command editing
12999* History:: Command history
13000* Screen Size:: Screen size
13001* Numbers:: Numbers
13002* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 13003* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
13004@end menu
13005
6d2ebf8b 13006@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
13007@section Prompt
13008
13009@cindex prompt
13010
13011@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
13012called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
13013can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
13014instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 13015the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
13016which one you are talking to.
13017
d4f3574e 13018@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
13019prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
13020or a prompt that does not.
13021
13022@table @code
13023@kindex set prompt
13024@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
13025Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
13026
13027@kindex show prompt
13028@item show prompt
13029Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
13030@end table
13031
6d2ebf8b 13032@node Editing
c906108c
SS
13033@section Command editing
13034@cindex readline
13035@cindex command line editing
13036
13037@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
13038@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
13039command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
13040or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
13041substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
13042debugging sessions.
13043
13044You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
13045command @code{set}.
13046
13047@table @code
13048@kindex set editing
13049@cindex editing
13050@item set editing
13051@itemx set editing on
13052Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
13053
13054@item set editing off
13055Disable command line editing.
13056
13057@kindex show editing
13058@item show editing
13059Show whether command line editing is enabled.
13060@end table
13061
6d2ebf8b 13062@node History
c906108c
SS
13063@section Command history
13064
13065@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
13066debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
13067happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
13068history facility.
13069
13070@table @code
13071@cindex history substitution
13072@cindex history file
13073@kindex set history filename
13074@kindex GDBHISTFILE
13075@item set history filename @var{fname}
13076Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
13077This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
13078list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
13079exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
13080the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
13081to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
13082@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
13083is not set.
c906108c
SS
13084
13085@cindex history save
13086@kindex set history save
13087@item set history save
13088@itemx set history save on
13089Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
13090@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
13091
13092@item set history save off
13093Stop recording command history in a file.
13094
13095@cindex history size
13096@kindex set history size
13097@item set history size @var{size}
13098Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
13099This defaults to the value of the environment variable
13100@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
13101@end table
13102
13103@cindex history expansion
13104History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
13105@ifset have-readline-appendices
13106@xref{Event Designators}.
13107@end ifset
13108
13109Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
13110is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
13111@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
13112follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
13113a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
13114history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
13115@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
13116
13117The commands to control history expansion are:
13118
13119@table @code
13120@kindex set history expansion
13121@item set history expansion on
13122@itemx set history expansion
13123Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
13124
13125@item set history expansion off
13126Disable history expansion.
13127
13128The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
13129editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
13130or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
13131@ifset have-readline-appendices
13132@xref{Command Line Editing}.
13133@end ifset
13134
13135@c @group
13136@kindex show history
13137@item show history
13138@itemx show history filename
13139@itemx show history save
13140@itemx show history size
13141@itemx show history expansion
13142These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
13143@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
13144@c @end group
13145@end table
13146
13147@table @code
41afff9a 13148@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
13149@item show commands
13150Display the last ten commands in the command history.
13151
13152@item show commands @var{n}
13153Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
13154
13155@item show commands +
13156Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
13157@end table
13158
6d2ebf8b 13159@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
13160@section Screen size
13161@cindex size of screen
13162@cindex pauses in output
13163
13164Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
13165information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
13166@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
13167output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
13168to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
13169determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
13170printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
13171rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
13172
d4f3574e
SS
13173Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
13174driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 13175together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 13176@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
13177you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
13178width} commands:
13179
13180@table @code
13181@kindex set height
13182@kindex set width
13183@kindex show width
13184@kindex show height
13185@item set height @var{lpp}
13186@itemx show height
13187@itemx set width @var{cpl}
13188@itemx show width
13189These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
13190a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
13191commands display the current settings.
13192
5d161b24
DB
13193If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
13194output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
13195file or to an editor buffer.
13196
13197Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
13198from wrapping its output.
13199@end table
13200
6d2ebf8b 13201@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
13202@section Numbers
13203@cindex number representation
13204@cindex entering numbers
13205
2df3850c
JM
13206You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
13207@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
13208@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
13209begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
13210default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
13211numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
13212change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
13213radix} command.
c906108c
SS
13214
13215@table @code
13216@kindex set input-radix
13217@item set input-radix @var{base}
13218Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
13219for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
13220specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
13221example, any of
13222
13223@smallexample
13224set radix 012
13225set radix 10.
13226set radix 0xa
13227@end smallexample
13228
13229@noindent
13230sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
13231leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
13232
13233@kindex set output-radix
13234@item set output-radix @var{base}
13235Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
13236for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
13237specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
13238
13239@kindex show input-radix
13240@item show input-radix
13241Display the current default base for numeric input.
13242
13243@kindex show output-radix
13244@item show output-radix
13245Display the current default base for numeric display.
13246@end table
13247
6d2ebf8b 13248@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
13249@section Optional warnings and messages
13250
2df3850c
JM
13251By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
13252running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
13253command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
13254internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
13255
13256Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
13257which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
13258see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
13259
13260@table @code
13261@kindex set verbose
13262@item set verbose on
13263Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13264
13265@item set verbose off
13266Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13267
13268@kindex show verbose
13269@item show verbose
13270Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
13271@end table
13272
2df3850c
JM
13273By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
13274object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
13275find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
13276symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
13277
13278@table @code
2df3850c 13279
c906108c
SS
13280@kindex set complaints
13281@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
13282Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
13283unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
13284@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
13285to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
13286
13287@kindex show complaints
13288@item show complaints
13289Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 13290
c906108c
SS
13291@end table
13292
13293By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
13294lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
13295you try to run a program which is already running:
13296
13297@example
13298(@value{GDBP}) run
13299The program being debugged has been started already.
13300Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
13301@end example
13302
13303If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
13304commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
13305
13306@table @code
2df3850c 13307
c906108c
SS
13308@kindex set confirm
13309@cindex flinching
13310@cindex confirmation
13311@cindex stupid questions
13312@item set confirm off
13313Disables confirmation requests.
13314
13315@item set confirm on
13316Enables confirmation requests (the default).
13317
13318@kindex show confirm
13319@item show confirm
13320Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 13321
c906108c
SS
13322@end table
13323
6d2ebf8b 13324@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
13325@section Optional messages about internal happenings
13326@table @code
13327@kindex set debug arch
13328@item set debug arch
13329Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
13330@kindex show debug arch
13331@item show debug arch
13332Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
13333@kindex set debug event
13334@item set debug event
13335Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
13336default is off.
13337@kindex show debug event
13338@item show debug event
13339Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
13340info.
13341@kindex set debug expression
13342@item set debug expression
13343Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
13344default is off.
13345@kindex show debug expression
13346@item show debug expression
13347Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
13348debugging info.
13349@kindex set debug overload
13350@item set debug overload
b37052ae 13351Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
5d161b24
DB
13352info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13353is off.
13354@kindex show debug overload
13355@item show debug overload
b37052ae 13356Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
5d161b24
DB
13357debugging info.
13358@kindex set debug remote
13359@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13360@cindex serial connections, debugging
13361@item set debug remote
13362Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13363the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13364@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13365@kindex show debug remote
13366@item show debug remote
13367Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13368@kindex set debug serial
13369@item set debug serial
13370Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13371default is off.
13372@kindex show debug serial
13373@item show debug serial
13374Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13375info.
13376@kindex set debug target
13377@item set debug target
13378Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13379includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13380default is off.
13381@kindex show debug target
13382@item show debug target
13383Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13384info.
13385@kindex set debug varobj
13386@item set debug varobj
13387Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13388info. The default is off.
13389@kindex show debug varobj
13390@item show debug varobj
13391Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13392debugging info.
13393@end table
13394
6d2ebf8b 13395@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
13396@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
13397
13398Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
13399command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13400commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13401files.
c906108c
SS
13402
13403@menu
13404* Define:: User-defined commands
13405* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13406* Command Files:: Command files
13407* Output:: Commands for controlled output
13408@end menu
13409
6d2ebf8b 13410@node Define
c906108c
SS
13411@section User-defined commands
13412
13413@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
13414A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13415which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13416@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13417separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13418via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
13419
13420@smallexample
13421define adder
13422 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13423@end smallexample
13424
d4f3574e
SS
13425@noindent
13426To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
13427
13428@smallexample
13429adder 1 2 3
13430@end smallexample
13431
d4f3574e
SS
13432@noindent
13433This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 13434its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
13435reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13436functions calls.
13437
13438@table @code
2df3850c 13439
c906108c
SS
13440@kindex define
13441@item define @var{commandname}
13442Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13443by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
13444
13445The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13446which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13447commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13448
13449@kindex if
13450@kindex else
13451@item if
13452Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13453It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13454only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13455There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13456by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13457was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13458
13459@kindex while
13460@item while
13461The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13462which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13463execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13464The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13465evaluates to true.
13466
13467@kindex document
13468@item document @var{commandname}
13469Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
13470accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13471defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13472reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13473After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
13474@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
13475
13476You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13477documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13478does not change the documentation.
13479
13480@kindex help user-defined
13481@item help user-defined
13482List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13483(if any) for each.
13484
13485@kindex show user
13486@item show user
13487@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
13488Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13489not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 13490definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 13491
c906108c
SS
13492@end table
13493
13494When user-defined commands are executed, the
13495commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13496stops execution of the user-defined command.
13497
13498If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
13499without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13500commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
13501messages when used in a user-defined command.
13502
6d2ebf8b 13503@node Hooks
c906108c 13504@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
13505@cindex command hooks
13506@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 13507@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 13508
c78b4128
EZ
13509@kindex hook
13510@kindex hook-
13511You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
13512command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13513command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13514before that command.
13515
c78b4128
EZ
13516@cindex hooks, post-command
13517@kindex hookpost
13518@kindex hookpost-
13519A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13520Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13521@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13522that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13523pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
13524
13525It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13526occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
13527
13528@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13529@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
13530
d4f3574e 13531@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
13532In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13533(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13534execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13535displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
13536
c906108c
SS
13537For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13538single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13539you could define:
13540
13541@example
13542define hook-stop
13543handle SIGALRM nopass
13544end
13545
13546define hook-run
13547handle SIGALRM pass
13548end
13549
13550define hook-continue
13551handle SIGLARM pass
13552end
13553@end example
c906108c 13554
c78b4128
EZ
13555As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13556command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13557you could define:
13558
13559@example
13560define hook-echo
13561echo <<<---
13562end
13563
13564define hookpost-echo
13565echo --->>>\n
13566end
13567
13568(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13569<<<---Hello World--->>>
13570(@value{GDBP})
13571
13572@end example
13573
c906108c
SS
13574You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13575not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13576name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13577@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13578@c or not?
13579If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13580@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13581(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13582
13583If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13584get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13585
6d2ebf8b 13586@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
13587@section Command files
13588
13589@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
13590A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13591commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13592An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
13593the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13594
13595@cindex init file
13596@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 13597@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 13598When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
96565e91
CF
13599@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13600port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13601limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13602During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
bf0184be
ND
13603
13604@enumerate
13605@item
13606Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13607DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13608@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13609
13610@item
13611Processes command line options and operands.
13612
13613@item
13614Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13615
13616@item
13617Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13618@end enumerate
13619
13620The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13621complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13622and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13623option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13624
c906108c
SS
13625@cindex init file name
13626On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13627different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13628form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13629different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13630environments with special init file names:
13631
00e4a2e4 13632@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
13633@itemize @bullet
13634@item
00e4a2e4 13635VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13636
00e4a2e4 13637@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13638@item
00e4a2e4 13639OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13640
00e4a2e4 13641@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 13642@item
00e4a2e4 13643ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 13644@end itemize
c906108c
SS
13645
13646You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13647@code{source} command:
13648
13649@table @code
13650@kindex source
13651@item source @var{filename}
13652Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13653@end table
13654
13655The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13656printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
13657of the command file.
13658
13659Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13660without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13661normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13662when called from command files.
13663
b433d00b
DH
13664@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13665mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13666standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13667not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13668the next command.
13669
13670@example
13671gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13672@end example
13673
13674(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13675will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13676would be directed to @file{log}.
13677
6d2ebf8b 13678@node Output
c906108c
SS
13679@section Commands for controlled output
13680
13681During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13682@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13683explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13684describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13685want.
13686
13687@table @code
13688@kindex echo
13689@item echo @var{text}
13690@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13691@c because it is not in ANSI.
13692Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13693@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13694newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13695In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13696by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13697string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 13698trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
13699To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13700@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13701
13702A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13703the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13704
13705@example
13706echo This is some text\n\
13707which is continued\n\
13708onto several lines.\n
13709@end example
13710
13711produces the same output as
13712
13713@example
13714echo This is some text\n
13715echo which is continued\n
13716echo onto several lines.\n
13717@end example
13718
13719@kindex output
13720@item output @var{expression}
13721Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13722newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 13723value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
13724on expressions.
13725
13726@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13727Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13728the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13729formats}, for more information.
13730
13731@kindex printf
13732@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13733Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13734@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13735either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13736@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13737subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
13738@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13739@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13740@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13741@c supported.
c906108c
SS
13742
13743@example
13744printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13745@end example
13746
13747For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13748
13749@smallexample
13750printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13751@end smallexample
13752
13753The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13754string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13755letter.
13756@end table
13757
c4555f82
SC
13758@node TUI
13759@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13760@cindex TUI
13761
13762@menu
13763* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13764* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13765* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13766* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13767@end menu
13768
13769The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13770is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13771to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13772and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13773The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13774with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13775
13776@node TUI Overview
13777@section TUI overview
13778
13779The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13780@value{GDBN} runs:
13781
13782@itemize @bullet
13783@item
13784A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13785windows on the terminal.
13786
13787@item
13788A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13789the TUI.
13790@end itemize
13791
13792In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13793on the terminal:
13794
13795@table @emph
13796@item command
13797This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13798prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13799managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13800window is always visible.
13801
13802@item source
13803The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13804line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13805The current program position is shown with the @samp{>} marker and
13806active breakpoints are shown with @samp{*} markers.
13807
13808@item assembly
13809The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13810
13811@item register
13812This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13813a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13814changed are highlighted.
13815
13816@end table
13817
13818The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13819and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13820changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13821These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13822layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13823The following layouts are available:
13824
13825@itemize @bullet
13826@item
13827source
13828
13829@item
13830assembly
13831
13832@item
13833source and assembly
13834
13835@item
13836source and registers
13837
13838@item
13839assembly and registers
13840
13841@end itemize
13842
13843@node TUI Keys
13844@section TUI Key Bindings
13845@cindex TUI key bindings
13846
13847The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13848(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13849They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13850directly on the TUI layout and windows. The following key bindings
13851are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13852
13853@table @kbd
13854@kindex C-x C-a
13855@item C-x C-a
13856@kindex C-x a
13857@itemx C-x a
13858@kindex C-x A
13859@itemx C-x A
13860Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13861the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13862its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13863mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13864The screen is then refreshed.
13865
13866@kindex C-x 1
13867@item C-x 1
13868Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13869either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13870is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13871
13872Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13873
13874@kindex C-x 2
13875@item C-x 2
13876Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13877layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13878When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13879previous layout and the new one.
13880
13881Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13882
13883@end table
13884
13885The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13886
13887@table @key
13888@kindex PgUp
13889@item PgUp
13890Scroll the active window one page up.
13891
13892@kindex PgDn
13893@item PgDn
13894Scroll the active window one page down.
13895
13896@kindex Up
13897@item Up
13898Scroll the active window one line up.
13899
13900@kindex Down
13901@item Down
13902Scroll the active window one line down.
13903
13904@kindex Left
13905@item Left
13906Scroll the active window one column left.
13907
13908@kindex Right
13909@item Right
13910Scroll the active window one column right.
13911
13912@kindex C-L
13913@item C-L
13914Refresh the screen.
13915
13916@end table
13917
13918In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13919for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13920necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13921@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13922
13923@node TUI Commands
13924@section TUI specific commands
13925@cindex TUI commands
13926
13927The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13928These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13929the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13930is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13931in the TUI mode.
13932
13933@table @code
13934@item layout next
13935@kindex layout next
13936Display the next layout.
13937
13938@item layout prev
13939@kindex layout prev
13940Display the previous layout.
13941
13942@item layout src
13943@kindex layout src
13944Display the source window only.
13945
13946@item layout asm
13947@kindex layout asm
13948Display the assembly window only.
13949
13950@item layout split
13951@kindex layout split
13952Display the source and assembly window.
13953
13954@item layout regs
13955@kindex layout regs
13956Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13957
13958@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13959@kindex focus
13960Set the focus to the named window.
13961This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13962can be affected to another window.
13963
13964@item refresh
13965@kindex refresh
13966Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13967
13968@item update
13969@kindex update
13970Update the source window and the current execution point.
13971
13972@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13973@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13974@kindex winheight
13975Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13976lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13977decrease it.
13978
13979@end table
13980
13981@node TUI Configuration
13982@section TUI configuration variables
13983@cindex TUI configuration variables
13984
13985The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13986appearance of windows on the terminal.
13987
13988@table @code
732b3002
SC
13989@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13990@kindex set tui border-kind
c4555f82
SC
13991Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13992The possible values are the following:
13993@table @code
13994@item space
13995Use a space character to draw the border.
13996
13997@item ascii
13998Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
13999
14000@item acs
14001Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
14002drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
14003
14004@end table
14005
732b3002
SC
14006@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
14007@kindex set tui active-border-mode
c4555f82
SC
14008Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
14009The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
14010@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
14011
732b3002
SC
14012@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
14013@kindex set tui border-mode
c4555f82
SC
14014Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
14015The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
14016@table @code
14017@item normal
14018Use normal attributes to display the border.
14019
14020@item standout
14021Use standout mode.
14022
14023@item reverse
14024Use reverse video mode.
14025
14026@item half
14027Use half bright mode.
14028
14029@item half-standout
14030Use half bright and standout mode.
14031
14032@item bold
14033Use extra bright or bold mode.
14034
14035@item bold-standout
14036Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
14037
14038@end table
14039
14040@end table
14041
6d2ebf8b 14042@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
14043@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
14044
14045@cindex Emacs
14046@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
14047A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
14048edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
14049@value{GDBN}.
14050
14051To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
14052executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
14053@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
14054created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 14055@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
14056
14057Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
14058things:
14059
14060@itemize @bullet
14061@item
14062All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
14063@end itemize
14064
14065This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
14066and output done by the program you are debugging.
14067
14068This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
14069commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
14070in this way.
14071
14072All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
14073with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
14074way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
14075stop.
14076
14077@itemize @bullet
14078@item
14079@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
14080@end itemize
14081
14082Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
14083source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
14084left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
14085source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
14086and the source.
14087
14088Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
14089usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
14090
14091@quotation
14092@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
14093current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
14094the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
14095appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
14096environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
14097session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
14098back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
14099avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
14100your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
14101@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
14102
14103A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
14104switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
14105@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
14106@end quotation
14107
14108By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
14109you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
14110several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
14111Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
14112
14113@example
14114(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
14115@end example
14116
14117@noindent
d4f3574e 14118(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
14119in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
14120``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
14121
14122In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
14123addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
14124
14125@table @kbd
14126@item C-h m
14127Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
14128
14129@item M-s
14130Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
14131update the display window to show the current file and location.
14132
14133@item M-n
14134Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
14135calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
14136to show the current file and location.
14137
14138@item M-i
14139Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
14140display window accordingly.
14141
14142@item M-x gdb-nexti
14143Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
14144display window accordingly.
14145
14146@item C-c C-f
14147Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
14148@code{finish} command.
14149
14150@item M-c
14151Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
14152command.
14153
14154@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
14155
14156@item M-u
14157Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
14158(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
14159like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
14160
14161@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
14162
14163@item M-d
14164Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
14165@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
14166
14167@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
14168
14169@item C-x &
14170Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
14171of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
14172around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
14173then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
14174argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
14175
14176You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
14177@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
14178otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
14179inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
14180wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
14181list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
14182formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
14183is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
14184@end table
14185
14186In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
14187tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
14188
14189If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14190it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14191request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14192the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14193frame.
14194
14195The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14196which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14197the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14198communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14199delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14200to correspond properly with the code.
14201
14202@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14203@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14204@ignore
14205@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14206@kindex Epoch
14207@kindex inspect
14208
5d161b24 14209Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
14210called the @code{epoch}
14211environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14212@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14213each value is printed in its own window.
14214@end ignore
c906108c 14215
d700128c 14216@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 14217@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 14218
6d2ebf8b 14219@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
14220@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
14221@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
14222@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
14223
14224Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
14225
14226Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
14227may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
14228the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
14229reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
14230
14231In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
14232information that enables us to fix the bug.
14233
14234@menu
14235* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
14236* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
14237@end menu
14238
6d2ebf8b 14239@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
14240@section Have you found a bug?
14241@cindex bug criteria
14242
14243If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
14244
14245@itemize @bullet
14246@cindex fatal signal
14247@cindex debugger crash
14248@cindex crash of debugger
14249@item
14250If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
14251@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
14252
14253@cindex error on valid input
14254@item
14255If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
14256bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
14257somewhere in the connection to the target.)
14258
14259@cindex invalid input
14260@item
14261If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
14262that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
14263``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
14264for traditional practice''.
14265
14266@item
14267If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
14268for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
14269@end itemize
14270
6d2ebf8b 14271@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
14272@section How to report bugs
14273@cindex bug reports
14274@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
14275
c906108c
SS
14276A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
14277If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
14278contact that organization first.
14279
14280You can find contact information for many support companies and
14281individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
14282distribution.
14283@c should add a web page ref...
14284
14285In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
14286@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
14287
14288@example
d4f3574e 14289bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
14290@end example
14291
14292@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 14293@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
14294not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
14295@samp{bug-gdb}.
14296
14297The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
14298serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
14299the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
14300newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
14301problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
14302path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
14303we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
14304bug reports to the mailing list.
14305
14306As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
14307
14308@example
14309@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
14310Free Software Foundation Inc.
1431159 Temple Place - Suite 330
14312Boston, MA 02111-1307
14313USA
14314@end example
c906108c
SS
14315
14316The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
14317@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
14318fact or leave it out, state it!
14319
14320Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
14321problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
14322assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
14323Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
14324stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
14325name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
14326of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
14327the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
14328easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
14329
14330Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
14331bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
14332you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
14333self-contained.
14334
14335Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
14336bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
14337@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
14338bugs properly.
14339
14340To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
14341
14342@itemize @bullet
14343@item
14344The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
14345with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
14346version}.
14347
14348Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
14349the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
14350
14351@item
14352The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
14353version number.
14354
c906108c
SS
14355@item
14356What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
14357``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
14358
14359@item
14360What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
14361debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
14362C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
14363information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
14364compilers.
14365
14366@item
14367The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
14368observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
14369you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
14370Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
14371
14372If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
14373and then we might not encounter the bug.
14374
14375@item
14376A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
14377reproduce the bug.
14378
14379@item
14380A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
14381incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
14382
14383Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
14384will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
14385not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
14386a chance to make a mistake.
14387
14388Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
14389say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
14390copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
14391the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
14392crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
14393ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
14394us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
14395to draw any conclusion from our observations.
14396
c906108c
SS
14397@item
14398If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
14399diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
14400it by context, not by line number.
14401
14402The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
14403sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 14404
c906108c
SS
14405@end itemize
14406
14407Here are some things that are not necessary:
14408
14409@itemize @bullet
14410@item
14411A description of the envelope of the bug.
14412
14413Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
14414which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
14415changes will not affect it.
14416
14417This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
14418will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
14419with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
14420We recommend that you save your time for something else.
14421
14422Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
14423of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
14424output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
14425less time, and so on.
14426
14427However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
14428report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
14429
14430@item
14431A patch for the bug.
14432
14433A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
14434the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
14435a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
14436to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
14437
14438Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
14439construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
14440through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
14441to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
14442
14443And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
14444patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
14445help us to understand.
14446
14447@item
14448A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
14449
14450Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
14451things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
14452@end itemize
14453
5d161b24 14454@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
14455@c and consists of the two following files:
14456@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 14457@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
14458@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
14459@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
14460@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 14461@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
14462
14463
6d2ebf8b 14464@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
14465@appendix Formatting Documentation
14466
14467@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
14468@cindex reference card
14469The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
14470for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
14471subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
14472@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
14473release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
14474you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
14475
14476The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
14477can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
14478
14479@example
14480make refcard.dvi
14481@end example
14482
5d161b24
DB
14483The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
14484mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
14485that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
14486high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
14487your @sc{dvi} output program.
14488
14489@cindex documentation
14490
14491All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
14492distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
14493a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
14494on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
14495formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
14496and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
14497
14498@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
14499version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
14500file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
14501subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
14502necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
14503but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
14504Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
14505@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
14506
14507If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
14508Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
14509@code{makeinfo}.
14510
14511If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
14512@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
14513version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
14514
14515@example
14516cd gdb
14517make gdb.info
14518@end example
14519
14520If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
14521a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
14522Texinfo definitions file.
14523
14524@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
14525produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
14526document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
14527has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
14528command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14529(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14530require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
14531
14532@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14533@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14534written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14535typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14536and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14537directory.
14538
14539If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14540typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14541subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14542@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
14543
14544@example
14545make gdb.dvi
14546@end example
14547
14548Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 14549
6d2ebf8b 14550@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
14551@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14552@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14553@cindex installation
14554
c906108c
SS
14555@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14556of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14557build the @code{gdb} program.
14558@iftex
14559@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14560@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14561look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14562installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14563@end iftex
14564
5d161b24
DB
14565The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14566@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
14567appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
14568
14569For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14570@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
14571
14572@table @code
14573@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14574script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
14575
14576@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14577the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
14578
14579@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14580source for the Binary File Descriptor library
14581
14582@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14583@sc{gnu} include files
14584
14585@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14586source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
14587
14588@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14589source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
14590
14591@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14592source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
14593
14594@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14595source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
14596
14597@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14598source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14599@end table
14600
14601The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14602from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14603this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
14604
14605First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14606if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14607identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14608argument.
14609
14610For example:
14611
14612@example
14613cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14614./configure @var{host}
14615make
14616@end example
14617
14618@noindent
14619where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14620@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14621(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14622correct value by examining your system.)
14623
14624Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14625@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14626libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14627binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
14628
14629@need 750
14630@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14631system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14632shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
14633
14634@example
14635sh configure @var{host}
14636@end example
14637
14638If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14639directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14640@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14641creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14642you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14643
14644You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14645subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14646configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
14647
14648For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14649the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
14650
14651@example
14652@group
14653cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14654../configure @var{host}
14655@end group
14656@end example
14657
14658You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14659However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14660the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14661that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14662let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
14663
14664@menu
14665* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14666* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14667* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14668@end menu
14669
6d2ebf8b 14670@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
14671@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14672
14673If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14674you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14675host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14676allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14677rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14678handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14679@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14680program specified there.
14681
14682To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14683with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14684(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14685itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14686would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14687the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
14688
5d161b24 14689For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
14690separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
14691
14692@example
14693@group
14694cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14695mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14696cd ../gdb-sun4
14697../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14698make
14699@end group
14700@end example
14701
14702When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14703directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14704(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14705the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14706directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14707@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
14708
14709One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
14710directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14711@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14712programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
14713You specify a cross-debugging target by
14714giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
14715
14716When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14717it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14718called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
14719
14720The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14721directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14722directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14723directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14724will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
14725
14726When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14727directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14728if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14729with each other.
14730
6d2ebf8b 14731@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
14732@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
14733
14734The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14735script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14736aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14737of information in the following pattern:
14738
14739@example
14740@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
14741@end example
14742
14743For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14744or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14745option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
14746
14747The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14748any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14749aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14750@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14751script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14752abbreviations---for example:
14753
14754@smallexample
14755% sh config.sub i386-linux
14756i386-pc-linux-gnu
14757% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14758alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14759% sh config.sub hp9k700
14760hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14761% sh config.sub sun4
14762sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14763% sh config.sub sun3
14764m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14765% sh config.sub i986v
14766Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14767@end smallexample
14768
14769@noindent
14770@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14771directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
14772
6d2ebf8b 14773@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
14774@section @code{configure} options
14775
14776Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14777are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14778several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14779Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
14780
14781@example
14782configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14783 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14784 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14785 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14786 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14787 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14788 @var{host}
14789@end example
14790
14791@noindent
14792You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14793@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14794@samp{--}.
14795
14796@table @code
14797@item --help
14798Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
14799
14800@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14801Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14802@file{@var{dir}}.
14803
14804@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14805Configure the source to install programs under directory
14806@file{@var{dir}}.
14807
14808@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14809@need 2000
14810@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14811@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14812@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14813Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14814@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14815build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14816directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14817the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14818directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14819the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14820@var{dirname}.
14821
14822@item --norecursion
14823Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14824propagate configuration to subdirectories.
14825
14826@item --target=@var{target}
14827Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14828@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14829programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
14830
14831There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
14832
14833@item @var{host} @dots{}
14834Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
14835
14836There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14837@end table
14838
14839There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14840needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 14841
6d2ebf8b 14842@node Index
c906108c
SS
14843@unnumbered Index
14844
14845@printindex cp
14846
14847@tex
14848% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
14849% meantime:
14850\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
14851\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
14852\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
14853\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
14854\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
14855\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
14856\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
14857\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
14858\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
14859\page\colophon
14860% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
14861@end tex
14862
449f3b6c
AC
14863@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
14864@ifinfo
c906108c 14865@contents
449f3b6c
AC
14866@end ifinfo
14867@ifhtml
14868@contents
14869@end ifhtml
14870
c906108c 14871@bye